ChipFind - Datasheet

Part Number FDC37B72x

Download:  PDF   ZIP
FDC37B72x
128 Pin Enhanced Super I/O Controller with
ACPI Support
FEATURES
·
5 Volt Operation
·
PC98/99 and ACPI 1.0 Compliant
·
Battery Back-up for Wake-Events
·
ISA Host Interface
·
ISA Plug-and-Play Compatible Register
Set
-
12 IRQ Options
-
15 Serial IRQ Options
-
16 Bit Address Qualification
-
Four DMA Options
-
12mA AT Bus Drivers
·
BIOS Buffer
·
20 GPI/O Pins
·
32 kHz Standby Clock Output
·
Soft Power Management
·
ACPI/PME Support
·
SCI/SMI Support
-
Watchdog timer
-
Power Button Override Event
-
Either Edge Triggered Interrupts
·
Intelligent Auto Power Management
-
Shadowed Write-only Registers
-
Programmable Wake-up Event
Interface
·
8042 Keyboard Controller
-
2K Program ROM
-
256 Bytes Data RAM
-
Asynchronous Access to Two Data
Registers and One Status Register
-
Supports Interrupt and Polling Access
-
8 Bit Timer/Counter
-
Port 92 Support
-
Fast Gate A20 and Hardware Keyboard
Reset
·
2.88MB Super I/O Floppy Disk Controller
-
Relocatable to 480 Different Addresses
-
Licensed CMOS 765B Floppy Disk
Controller
-
Advanced Digital Data Separator
-
SMSC's Proprietary 82077AA
Compatible Core
-
Sophisticated Power Control Circuitry
(PCC) Including Multiple Powerdown
Modes for Reduced Power
Consumption
-
Supports Two Floppy Drives Directly
-
Software Write Protect
-
FDC on Parallel Port
-
Low Power CMOS Design
-
Supports Vertical Recording Format
-
16 Byte Data FIFO
-
100% IBM® Compatibility
-
Detects All Overrun and Underrun
Conditions
-
24mA Drivers and Schmitt Trigger Inputs
·
Enhanced FDC Digital Data Separator
-
Low Cost Implementation
-
No Filter Components Required
-
2 Mbps, 1 Mbps, 500 Kbps, 300 Kbps,
250 Kbps Data Rates
2
-
Programmable Precompensation
Modes
·
Serial Ports
-
Relocatable to 480 Different
Addresses
-
Two High Speed NS16C550A
Compatible UARTs with
Send/Receive 16 Byte FIFOs
-
Programmable Baud Rate
Generator
-
Modem Control Circuitry Including
230K and 460K Baud
-
IrDA 1.0, HP-SIR, ASK-IR Support
-
Ring Wake Filter
·
Multi-Mode
TM
Parallel Port with ChiProtect
TM
-
Relocatable to 480 Different Addresses
-
Standard Mode
-
IBM PC/XT
®
, PC/AT
®
, and PS/2
TM
Compatible Bidirectional ParallelPort
-
Enhanced Mode
-
Enhanced Parallel Port (EPP)
Compatible EPP 1.7 and EPP 1.9
(IEEE 1284 Compliant)
-
High Speed Mode
-
Microsoft and Hewlett Packard
Extended Capabilities Port (ECP)
Compatible (IEEE 1284 Compliant)
-
Incorporates ChiProtect
TM
Circuitry for
Protection Against Damage Due to
Printer Power-On
-
14 mA Output Drivers
·
128 Pin QFP Package
3
TABLE OF CONTENTS
FEATURES ....................................................................................................................................... 1
GENERAL DESCRIPTION................................................................................................................. 5
DESCRIPTION OF PIN FUNCTIONS ................................................................................................ 7
BUFFER TYPE DESCRIPTIONS........................................................................................ 10
GENERAL PURPOSE I/O PINS....................................................................................................... 11
REFERENCE DOCUMENTS ........................................................................................................... 12
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ......................................................................................................... 14
SUPER I/O REGISTERS.................................................................................................... 14
HOST PROCESSOR INTERFACE ..................................................................................... 14
FLOPPY DISK CONTROLLER ........................................................................................................ 15
FDC INTERNAL REGISTERS.......................................................................................................... 15
COMMAND SET/DESCRIPTIONS ................................................................................................... 38
INSTRUCTION SET ........................................................................................................................ 41
DATA TRANSFER COMMANDS ........................................................................................ 53
CONTROL COMMANDS.................................................................................................... 62
SERIAL PORT (UART) .................................................................................................................... 69
INFRARED INTERFACE .................................................................................................... 85
PARALLEL PORT............................................................................................................................ 86
IBM XT/AT COMPATIBLE, BI-DIRECTIONAL AND EPP MODES....................................... 88
EXTENDED CAPABILITIES PARALLEL PORT ................................................................................ 94
OPERATION.....................................................................................................................102
PARALLEL PORT FLOPPY DISK CONTROLLER...........................................................................107
POWER MANAGEMENT................................................................................................................109
UART POWER MANAGEMENT ........................................................................................113
PARALLEL PORT .............................................................................................................113
INTERNAL PWRGOOD ....................................................................................................113
32.768
K
H
Z
STANDBY CLOCK OUTPUT...........................................................................114
SERIAL IRQ ...................................................................................................................................115
BIOS BUFFER................................................................................................................................120
GENERAL PURPOSE I/O...............................................................................................................121
DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................121
RUN STATE GPIO DATA REGISTER ACCESS ................................................................122
GPIO CONFIGURATION ..................................................................................................123
WATCH DOG TIMER .....................................................................................................................126
8042 KEYBOARD CONTROLLER DESCRIPTION ..........................................................................128
SOFT POWER MANAGEMENT......................................................................................................136
BUTTON OVERRIDE FEATURE .......................................................................................139
4
ACPI/PME/SMI FEATURES............................................................................................................141
ACPI FEATURES..............................................................................................................141
PME SUPPORT ................................................................................................................143
ACPI, PME AND SMI REGISTERS ...................................................................................143
E
ITHER
E
DGE
T
RIGGERED
I
NTERRUPTS
...................................................................................155
CONFIGURATION..........................................................................................................................158
SYSTEM ELEMENTS .......................................................................................................158
CONFIGURATION SEQUENCE......................................................................................... 10
CONFIGURATION
REGISTERS .......................................................................................161
OPERATIONAL DESCRIPTION......................................................................................................204
MAXIMUM GUARANTEED RATINGS* ..............................................................................204
DC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS.............................................................................204
AC TIMING .......................................................................................................................209
CAPACITIVE LOADING ....................................................................................................209
ECP PARALLEL PORT TIMING ........................................................................................234
80 Arkay Dr.
Hauppauge, NY 11788
(516) 435-6000
FAX: (516) 273-3123
5
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
The FDC37B72x incorporates a keyboard
interface, SMSC's true CMOS 765B floppy disk
controller, advanced digital data separator, 16
byte data FIFO, two 16C550 compatible UARTs,
one Multi-Mode parallel port which includes
ChiProtect circuitry plus EPP and ECP support,
on-chip 12 mA AT bus drivers, and two floppy
direct drive support, soft power management
and SMI support and Intelligent Power
Management including PME and SCI/ACPI
support. The true CMOS 765B core provides
100% compatibility with IBM PC/XT and PC/AT
architectures in addition to providing data
overflow and underflow protection. The SMSC
advanced digital data separator incorporates
SMSC's patented data separator technology,
allowing for ease of testing and use. Both on-
chip UARTs are compatible with the NS16C550.
The parallel port is compatible with IBM PC/AT
architecture, as well as EPP and ECP. The
FDC37B72x incorporates sophisticated power
control circuitry (PCC) which includes support
for keyboard, mouse, modem ring, power button
support and other wake-up events. The PCC
supports multiple low power down modes.
The FDC37B72x provides features for
compliance with the "Advanced Configuration
and Power Interface Specification" (ACPI).
These features include support of both legacy
and ACPI power management models through
the selection of SMI or SCI. It implements a
power button override event (4 second button
hold to turn off the system) and either edge
triggered interrupts.
The FDC37B72x provides support for the ISA
Plug-and-Play Standard (Version 1.0a) and
provides for the recommended functionality to
support Windows '95/'98 and PC98/PC99.
Through internal configuration registers, each of
the FDC37B72x's logical device's I/O address,
DMA channel and IRQ channel may be
programmed. There are 480 I/O address
location options, 12 IRQ pin options or Serial
IRQ option, and four DMA channel options for
each logical device.
The FDC37B72x Floppy Disk Controller and
data separator do not require any external filter
components and are therefore easy to use, offer
lower system cost and reduced board area. The
FDC is software and register compatible with
SMSC's proprietary 82077AA core.
IBM, PC/XT and PC/AT are registered trademarks and PS/2 is a trademark
of International Business Machines Corporation
SMSC is a registered trademark and Ultra I/O, ChiProtect, and Multi-Mode
are trademarks of Standard Microsystems Corporation
6
FIGURE 1 - FDC37B72x PIN CONFIGURATION
FDC37B72x
128 Pin QFP
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
IOCHRDY
TC
VCC
DRQ3
nDACK3
DRQ2
nDACK2
DRQ1
nDACK1
DRQ0
nDACK0
RESET_DRV
SD7
SD6
SD5
SD4
VSS
SD3
SD2
SD1
SD0
AEN
nIOW
nIOR
SER_IRQ/IRQ15
PCI_CLK/IRQ14/GP50
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
nCTS2
nRTS2
nDSR2
TXD2/IRTX
RXD2/IRRX
nDCD2
VCC
nRI2
nDCD1
nRI1
nDTR1
nCTS1
nRTS1/SYSOP
nDSR1
TXD1
RXD1
nSTROBE
nALF
nERROR
nACK
BUSY
PE
SLCT
VSS
PD7
nDTR2
3
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
0
1
1
1
2
1
3
1
4
1
5
1
6
1
7
1
8
1
9
2
0
2
1
2
2
2
3
2
4
2
5
2
6
2
7
2
8
2
9
3
0
3
1
3
3
3
4
3
5
3
6
3
7
3
8
D
R
V
D
E
N
0
D
R
V
D
E
N
1
/
G
P
5
2
/
I
R
Q
8
/
n
S
M
I
n
M
T
R
0
n
D
S
1
/
G
P
1
7
n
D
S
0
n
M
T
R
1
/
G
P
1
6
V
S
S
n
D
I
R
n
S
T
E
P
n
W
D
A
T
A
n
W
G
A
T
E
n
H
D
S
E
L
n
I
N
D
E
X
n
T
R
K
0
n
W
R
T
P
R
T
n
R
D
A
T
A
n
D
S
K
C
H
G
C
L
K
3
2
O
U
T
n
P
O
W
E
R
O
N
B
U
T
T
O
N
_
I
N
n
P
M
E
/
S
C
I
/
I
R
Q
9
C
L
O
C
K
I
S
A
9
S
A
0
S
A
1
S
A
2
S
A
4
S
A
6
S
A
7
S
A
8
S
A
3
S
A
5
S
A
1
0
S
A
1
1
S
A
1
2
S
A
1
3
S
A
1
4
S
A
1
5
P
D
0
n
S
L
C
T
I
N
n
I
N
I
T
V
C
C
n
R
O
M
O
E
/
I
R
Q
1
2
/
G
P
5
4
/
E
E
T
I
n
R
O
M
C
S
/
I
R
Q
1
1
/
G
P
5
3
/
E
E
T
I
R
D
7
/
I
R
Q
1
0
/
G
P
6
7
R
D
6
/
I
R
Q
8
/
G
P
6
6
R
D
5
/
I
R
Q
7
/
G
P
6
5
R
D
4
/
I
R
Q
6
/
G
P
6
4
/
P
1
7
R
D
3
/
I
R
Q
5
/
G
P
6
3
/
W
D
T
R
D
2
/
I
R
Q
4
/
G
P
6
2
/
n
R
I
N
G
R
D
1
/
I
R
Q
3
/
G
P
6
1
/
L
E
D
R
D
0
/
I
R
Q
1
/
G
P
6
0
/
n
S
M
I
K
C
L
K
K
D
A
T
V
T
R
X
T
A
L
2
A
V
S
S
X
T
A
L
1
G
P
1
5
/
I
R
T
X
2
V
B
A
T
G
P
1
4
/
I
R
R
X
2
G
P
1
3
/
L
E
D
G
P
1
2
/
W
D
T
/
P
1
7
/
E
E
T
I
G
P
1
1
/
n
R
I
N
G
/
E
E
T
I
G
P
1
0
/
n
S
M
I
A
2
0
M
K
B
D
R
S
T
V
S
S
M
C
L
K
M
D
A
T
P
D
6
P
D
5
P
D
4
P
D
3
P
D
2
P
D
1
1
0
2
1
0
1
1
0
0

9
9

9
8

9
7

9
6

9
5

9
4

9
3

9
2

9
1

9
0

8
9

8
8

8
7

8
6

8
5

8
4

8
3

8
2

8
1

8
0

7
9

7
8

7
7

7
6

7
5

7
4

7
3

7
2

7
1

7
0

6
9

6
8

6
7

6
6

6
5
7
DESCRIPTION OF PIN FUNCTIONS
TABLE 1 - DESCRIPTION OF PIN FUNCTIONS
PIN
No./QFP
NAME
TOTAL
SYMBOL
BUFFER TYPE
PROCESSOR/HOST INTERFACE (40)
44-47,
49-52
System Data Bus
8
SD[0:7]
IO12
23-38
16-bit System Address Bus
16
SA[0:15]
I
43
Address Enable
1
AEN
I
64
I/O Channel Ready
1
IOCHRDY
OD12
53
ISA Reset Drive
1
RESET_DRV
IS
40
Serial IRQ/IRQ15
1
SER_IRQ
IO12
39
PCI Clock/IRQ14/GP50
1
PCI_CLK
IO12
55
DMA Request 0
1
DRQ0
O12
57
DMA Request 1
1
DRQ1
O12
59
DMA Request 2
1
DRQ2
O12
54
DMA Acknowledge 0
1
nDACK0
I
56
DMA Acknowledge 1
1
nDACK1
I
58
DMA Acknowledge 2
1
nDACK2
I
61
DMA Request 3
1
DRQ3
O12
60
DMA Acknowledge 3
1
nDACK3
I
63
Terminal Count
1
TC
I
41
I/O Read
1
nIOR
I
42
I/O Write
1
nIOW
I
CLOCKS (4)
22
14.318MHz Clock Input
1
CLOCKI
ICLK
66
32.768kHz Crystal Input
1
XTAL1
ICLK
68
32.768kHz Crystal Driver
1
XTAL2
OCLK2
18
32.768kHz Clock Out
1
CLK32OUT
O8
POWER PINS (10)
62, 93,
121
+5V Supply Voltage
3
VCC
7, 48,
74, 104
Digital Ground
4
VSS
67
Analog Ground
1
AVSS
69
Trickle Supply Voltage
1
VTR
65
Battery Voltage
1
VBAT
POWER MANAGEMENT (3)
19
Power On
1
nPOWERON
OD24
20
Button In
1
BUTTON_IN
I
21
Power Management Event/SCI/IRQ9
1
nPME
O12
FDD INTERFACE (16)
16
Read Disk Data
1
nRDATA
IS
11
Write Gate
1
nWGATE
O24
8
PIN
No./QFP
NAME
TOTAL
SYMBOL
BUFFER TYPE
10
Write Disk Data
1
nWDATA
O24
12
Head Select
1
nHDSEL
O24
8
Step Direction
1
nDIR
O24
9
Step Pulse
1
nSTEP
O24
17
Disk Change
1
nDSKCHG
IS
5
Drive Select 0
1
nDS0
O24
6
Drive Select 1/GP17
1
nDS1
IO24
3
Motor On 0
1
nMTR0
O24
4
Motor On 1/GP16
1
nMTR1
IO24
15
Write Protected
1
nWRTPRT
IS
14
Track 0
1
nTRKO
IS
13
Index Pulse Input
1
nINDEX
IS
1
Drive Density Select 0
1
DRVDEN0
O24
2
Drive Density Select 1/GP52/IRQ8/nSMI
1
DRVDEN1
IO24
GENERAL PURPOSE I/O (6)
77
General Purpose 10/nSMI
1
GP10
IO12
78
General Purpose 11/nRING/EETI (Note 4)
1
GP11
IO4
79
General Purpose 12/WDT/P17/P12/EETI
(Note 4)
1
GP12
IO4
80
General Purpose 13/LED Driver
1
GP13
IO24
81
General Purpose 14/Infrared Rx
1
GP14
IO4
82
General Purpose 15/Infrared Tx (Note 3)
1
GP15
IO24
BIOS INTERFACE (10)
83
ROM Bus 0/IRQ1/GP60/nSMI
1
RD0
IO12
84
ROM Bus 1/IRQ3/GP61/LED
1
RD1
IO24
85
ROM Bus 2/IRQ4/GP62/nRING
1
RD2
IO12
86
ROM Bus 3/IRQ5/GP63/WDT
1
RD3
IO12
87
ROM Bus 4/IRQ6/GP64/P17/P12
1
RD4
IO12
88
ROM Bus 5/IRQ7/GP65
1
RD5
IO12
89
ROM Bus 6/IRQ8/GP66
1
RD6
IO12
90
ROM Bus 7/IRQ10/GP67
1
RD7
IO12
91
nROMCS/IRQ11/GP53/EETI (Note 4)
1
nROMCS
IO12
92
nROMOE/IRQ12/GP54/EETI (Note 4)
1
nROMOE
IO12
SERIAL PORT 1 INTERFACE (8)
112
Receive Serial Data 1
1
RXD1
I
113
Transmit Serial Data 1
1
TXD1
O4
115
Request to Send 1
1
nRTS1/
SYSOP
IO4
116
Clear to Send 1
1
nCTS1
I
117
Data Terminal Ready 1
1
nDTR1
O4
114
Data Set Ready 1
1
nDSR1
I
119
Data Carrier Detect 1
1
nDCD1
I
118
Ring Indicator 1
1
nRI1
I
9
PIN
No./QFP
NAME
TOTAL
SYMBOL
BUFFER TYPE
SERIAL PORT 2 INTERFACE (8)
123
Receive Serial Data 2/Infrared Rx
1
RXD2/IRRX
I
124
Transmit Serial Data 2/Infrared Tx (Note 3)
1
TXD2/IRTX
O24
126
Request to Send 2
1
nRTS2
O4
127
Clear to Send 2
1
nCTS2
I
128
Data Terminal Ready
1
nDTR2
O4
125
Data Set Ready 2
1
nDSR2
I
122
Data Carrier Detect 2
1
nDCD2
I
120
Ring Indicator 2
1
nRI2
I
PARALLEL PORT INTERFACE (17)
96-103
Parallel Port Data Bus
8
PD[0:7]
IOP14
95
Printer Select
1
nSLCTIN
OP14
94
Initiate Output
1
nINIT
OP14
110
Auto Line Feed
1
nALF
OP14
111
Strobe Signal
1
nSTROBE
OP14
107
Busy Signal
1
BUSY
I
108
Acknowledge Handshake
1
nACK
I
106
Paper End
1
PE
I
105
Printer Selected
1
SLCT
I
109
Error at Printer
1
nERROR
I
KEYBOARD/MOUSE INTERFACE (6)
70
Keyboard Data
1
KDAT
IOD16
71
Keyboard Clock
1
KCLK
IOD16
72
Mouse Data
1
MDAT
IOD16
73
Mouse Clock
1
MCLK
IOD16
75
Keyboard Reset
1
KBDRST
(Note 2)
O4
76
Gate A20
1
A20M
O4
Note 1: The "n" as the first letter of a signal name indicates an "Active Low" signal.
Note 2: KBDRST is active low.
Note 3: This pin defaults to an output and low. When configured as IRTX (or IRTX2), this pin is low
when the IR block is not transmitting.
Note 4: EETI is the Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Input function.
10
BUFFER TYPE DESCRIPTIONS
TABLE 2 - BUFFER TYPES
SYMBOL
DESCRIPTION
I
Input, TTL compatible.
IS
Input with Schmitt trigger.
ICLK
Clock Input.
OCLK2
Clock Output, 2mA sink, 2mA source.
IO4
Input/Output, 4mA sink, 2mA source.
IOP4
Input/Output, 4mA sink, 2mA source. Backdrive Protected.
O4
Output, 4mA sink, 2mA source.
O8
Output, 8mA sink, 4mA source.
IO12
Input/Output, 12mA sink, 6mA source.
O12
Output, 12mA sink, 6mA source.
OP12
Output, 12mA sink, 6mA source. Backdrive Protected.
OD12
Output, Open Drain, 12 mA sink.
IOP14
Input/Output, 14mA sink, 14mA source. Backdrive Protected.
OD14
Output, Open Drain, 14mA sink.
OP14
Output, 14mA sink, 14mA source. Backdrive Protected.
IOD16
Input/Output, Open Drain, 16mA sink
O24
Output, 24mA sink, 12mA source.
OD24
Output, Open Drain, 24mA sink.
11
GENERAL PURPOSE I/O PINS
TABLE 3 - GENERAL PURPOSE I/O PIN FUNCTIONS
PIN NO.
QFP
DEFAULT
FUNCTION
ALTERNATE
FUNCTION 1
ALTERNATE
FUNCTION 2
ALTERNATE
FUNCTION 3
BUFFER
TYPE
5
INDEX
REG.
GPIO
77
GPIO
nSMI
-
-
IOP4/(OP12/
OD12)
GP1
GP10
78
GPIO
nRING
EETI
1
-
IOP4/I/I
GP1
GP11
79
GPIO
WDT
P17/P12
4
EETI
1
IOP4/O4/IO4/I
GP1
GP12
80
GPIO
LED
-
-
IOP4/O24
GP1
GP13
81
GPIO
IRRX2
-
-
IOP4/I
GP1
GP14
82
GPIO
IRTX2
-
-
IOP4/O24
GP1
GP15
4
nMTR1
GPIO
-
-
(O24/OD24)/
IOP4
GP1
GP16
6
nDS1
GPIO
-
-
(O24/OD24)/
IOP4
GP1
GP17
39
PCI_CLK
IRQ14
GPIO
-
CLKIN/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4
GP5
GP50
2
DRVDEN1
GPIO
IRQ8
nSMI
(O24/OD24)
/IOP4/
(OP12/OD12)/
(OP12/OD12)
GP5
GP52
91
nROMCS
2
IRQ11
GPIO
EETI
1
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/I
GP5
GP53
92
nROMOE
2
IRQ12
GPIO
EETI
1
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/I
GP5
GP54
83
RD0
2,3
IRQ1
GPIO
nSMI
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/
(OP12/OD12)
GP6
GP60
84
RD1
2,3
IRQ3
GPIO
LED
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/
O24
GP6
GP61
85
RD2
2,3
IRQ4
GPIO
nRING
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/I
GP6
GP62
86
RD3
2,3
IRQ5
GPIO
WDT
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/
O4
GP6
GP63
87
RD4
2,3
IRQ6
GPIO
P17/P12
4
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4/
IO4
GP6
GP64
88
RD5
2,3
IRQ7
GPIO
-
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4
GP6
GP65
89
RD6
2,3
IRQ8
GPIO
-
IO12/(OP12/
OD12)/IOP4
GP6
GP66
90
RD7
2,3
IRQ10
GPIO
-
IO12/(O12/
OD12)/IOP4
GP6
GP67
Note 1: Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Inputs.
Note 2: At power-up, RD0-7, nROMCS and nROMOE function as the XD Bus. To use RD0-7 for
alternate functions, nROMCS must stay high until those pins are finished being programmed.
Note 3: These pins cannot be programmed as open drain pins in their original function.
Note 4: The function of P17 or P12 is selected via the P17/P12 select bit in the Ring Filter Select
Register in Logical Device 8 at 0xC6. Default is P17.
12
Note 5: Buffer types per function are separated by a forward slash "/". Multiple buffer types per
function are separated by a forward slash "/" and enclosed in parentheses; e.g., IRQ outputs
can be open drain or push-pull and are shown as "(O12/OD12)".
REFERENCE DOCUMENTS
§
IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Standard, Rev. 1.14, July 14, 1993.
§
Hardware Description of the 8042, Intel 8 bit Embedded Controller Handbook.
§
PCI Bus Power Management Interface Specification, Rev. 1.0, Draft, March 18, 1997.
13
FIGURE 2 - FDC37B72x BLOCK DIAGRAM
nDSR1, nDCD1, nRI1, nDTR1
TXD1
nINIT, nALF
HOST
CPU
MULTI-MODE
PARALLEL
PORT/FDC
MUX
16C550
COMPATIBLE
SERIAL
PORT 1
16C550
COMPATIBLE
SERIAL
PORT 2 WITH
INFRARED
CONFIGURATION
REGISTERS
POWER
MANAGEMENT
INTERFACE
CONTROL BUS
ADDRESS BUS
DATA BUS
nIOR
nIOW
AEN
SA[0:15]
SD[O:7]
DRQ[0:3]
nDACK[0:3]
IRQ[1,3-12,14]
RESET_DRV
nINDEX
nTRK0
nDSKCHG
nWRPRT
nWGATE
DENSEL
nDIR
nSTEP
nHDSEL
nDS0,1
nMTR0,1
RDATA
RCLOCK
WDATA
WCLOCK
nWDATA
nRDATA
TXD2(IRTX)
RXD2(IRRX)
nDSR2, nDCD2, nRI2, nDTR2
RXD1
PD0-7
BUSY, SLCT, PE,
nERROR , nACK
nSTB, nSLCTIN ,
TC
SMSC
PROPRIETARY
82077
COMPATIBLE
VERTICAL
FLOPPYDISK
CONTROLLER
CORE
DIGITAL
DATA
SEPARATOR
WITH WRITE
PRECOM-
PENSATION
IOCHRDY
BIOS
BUFFER
nROMOE *
nROMCS *
RD[0:7]*
GENERAL
PURPOSE
I/O
GP1[0:7]*
IRRX
8042
KCLK
KDATA
MCLK
MDATA
P20, P21
XTAL1
VBAT
DRVDEN0
DRVDEN1
*Multi-Function I/O Pin - Optional
P17/P12*
GP5[0,2:4]*
GP6[0:7]*
SOFT
POWER
MANAGEMENT
PME/
ACPI
nPowerOn
Button_In
nSMI*
VCC
nPME/SCI
SERIAL
IRQ
SER_IRQ
PCI_CLK
VSS
CLOCK
GEN
CLOCKI
(14.318)
CLK32OUT
nSMI
VTR
nCTS2, nRTS2
IRTX
nCTS1, nRTS1
XTAL2
14
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
SUPER I/O REGISTERS
The address map, shown below in Table 1,
shows the addresses of the different blocks of
the Super I/O immediately after power up. The
base addresses of the FDC, serial and parallel
ports can be moved via the configuration
registers. Some addresses are used to access
more than one register.
HOST PROCESSOR INTERFACE
The host processor communicates with the
FDC37B72x through a series of read/write
registers. The port addresses for these registers
are shown in Table 1. Register access is
accomplished through programmed I/O or DMA
transfers. All registers are 8 bits wide. All host
interface output buffers are capable of sinking a
minimum of 12 mA.
TABLE 4 - SUPER I/O BLOCK ADDRESSES
ADDRESS
BLOCK NAME
LOGICAL
DEVICE
NOTES
Base+(0-5) and +(7)
Floppy Disk
0
Base+(0-3)
Base+(0-7)
Base+(0-3), +(400-402)
Base+(0-7), +(400-402)
Parallel Port
SPP
EPP
ECP
ECP+EPP+SPP
3
Base+(0-7)
Serial Port Com 1
4
Base+(0-7)
Serial Port Com 2
5
IR Support
60, 64
KYBD
7
Base + (0-17h)
ACPI, PME, SMI
A
Base + (0-1)
Configuration
Note 1: Refer to the configuration register descriptions for setting the base address
15
FLOPPY DISK CONTROLLER
The Floppy Disk Controller (FDC) provides the
interface between a host microprocessor and
the floppy disk drives. The FDC integrates the
functions of the Formatter/Controller, Digital
Data Separator, Write Precompensation and
Data Rate Selection logic for an IBM XT/AT
compatible FDC. The true CMOS 765B core
guarantees 100% IBM PC XT/AT compatibility
in addition to providing data overflow and
underflow protection.
The FDC is compatible to the 82077AA using
SMSC's proprietary floppy disk controller core.
FDC INTERNAL REGISTERS
The Floppy Disk Controller contains eight
internal registers that facilitate the interfacing
between the host microprocessor and the disk
drive. TABLE 5 shows the addresses required
to access these registers. Registers other than
the ones shown are not supported. The rest of
the description assumes that the primary
addresses have been selected.
TABLE 5 - STATUS, DATA AND CONTROL REGISTERS
(Shown with base addresses of 3F0 and 370)
PRIMARY
ADDRESS
SECONDARY
ADDRESS
R/W
REGISTER
3F0
3F1
3F2
3F3
3F4
3F4
3F5
3F6
3F7
3F7
370
371
372
373
374
374
375
376
377
377
R
R
R/W
R/W
R
W
R/W
R
W
Status Register A (SRA)
Status Register B (SRB)
Digital Output Register (DOR)
Tape Drive Register (TSR)
Main Status Register (MSR)
Data Rate Select Register (DSR)
Data (FIFO)
Reserved
Digital Input Register (DIR)
Configuration Control Register (CCR)
16
STATUS REGISTER A (SRA)
Address 3F0 READ ONLY
This register is read-only and monitors the state
of the FINTR pin and several disk interface
pins in PS/2 and Model 30 modes. The SRA can
be accessed at any time when in PS/2 mode. In
the PC/AT mode the data bus pins D0 - D7 are
held in a high impedance state for a read of
address 3F0.
PS/2 Mode
BIT 0 DIRECTION
Active high status indicating the direction of
head movement. A logic "1" indicates inward
direction; a logic "0" indicates outward direction.
BIT 1 nWRITE PROTECT
Active low status of the WRITE PROTECT disk
interface input. A logic "0" indicates that the disk
is write protected. (See also Force Write Protect
Function)
BIT 2 nINDEX
Active low status of the INDEX disk interface
input.
BIT 3 HEAD SELECT
Active high status of the HDSEL disk interface
input. A logic "1" selects side 1 and a logic "0"
selects side 0.
BIT 4 nTRACK 0
Active low status of the TRK0 disk interface
input.
BIT 5 STEP
Active high status of the STEP output disk
interface output pin.
BIT 6 nDRV2
Active low status of the DRV2 disk interface
input pin, indicating that a second drive has
been installed. Note: This function is not
supported in this chip. (Always 1, indicating
1 drive)
BIT 7 INTERRUPT PENDING
Active high bit indicating the state of the Floppy
Disk Interrupt output.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INT
PENDING
nDRV2
STEP
nTRK0 HDSEL nINDX
nWP
DIR
RESET
COND.
0
1
0
N/A
0
N/A
N/A
0
17
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
BIT 0 nDIRECTION
Active low status indicating the direction of head
movement. A logic "0" indicates inward
direction; a logic "1" indicates outward direction.
BIT 1 WRITE PROTECT
Active high status of the WRITE PROTECT disk
interface input. A logic "1" indicates that the disk
is write protected. (See also Force Write
Protect Function)
BIT 2 INDEX
Active high status of the INDEX disk interface
input.
BIT 3 nHEAD SELECT
Active low status of the HDSEL disk interface
input. A logic "0" selects side 1 and a logic "1"
selects side 0.
BIT 4 TRACK 0
Active high status of the TRK0 disk interface
input.
BIT 5 STEP
Active high status of the latched STEP disk
interface output pin. This bit is latched with the
STEP output going active, and is cleared with a
read from the DIR register, or with a hardware
or software reset.
BIT 6 DMA REQUEST
Active high status of the DRQ output pin.
BIT 7 INTERRUPT PENDING
Active high bit indicating the state of the Floppy
Disk Interrupt output.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INT
PENDING
DRQ
STEP
F/F
TRK0
nHDSEL
INDX
WP
nDIR
RESET
COND.
0
0
0
N/A
1
N/A
N/A
1
18
STATUS REGISTER B (SRB)
Address 3F1 READ ONLY
This register is read-only and monitors the state
of several disk interface pins in PS/2 and Model
30 modes. The SRB can be accessed at any
time when in PS/2 mode. In the PC/AT mode
the data bus pins D0 - D7 are held in a high
impedance state for a read of address 3F1.
PS/2 Mode
BIT 0 MOTOR ENABLE 0
Active high status of the MTR0 disk interface
output pin. This bit is low after a hardware reset
and unaffected by a software reset.
BIT 1 MOTOR ENABLE 1
Active high status of the MTR1 disk interface
output pin. This bit is low after a hardware reset
and unaffected by a software reset.
BIT 2 WRITE GATE
Active high status of the WGATE disk interface
output.
BIT 3 READ DATA TOGGLE
Every inactive edge of the RDATA input causes
this bit to change state.
BIT 4 WRITE DATA TOGGLE
Every inactive edge of the WDATA input causes
this bit to change state.
BIT 5 DRIVE SELECT 0
Reflects the status of the Drive Select 0 bit of
the DOR (address 3F2 bit 0). This bit is cleared
after a hardware reset and it is unaffected by a
software reset.
BIT 6 RESERVED
Always read as a logic "1".
BIT 7 RESERVED
Always read as a logic "1".
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
DRIVE
SEL0
WDATA
TOGGLE
RDATA
TOGGLE
WGATE
MOT
EN1
MOT
EN0
RESET
COND.
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
19
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
BIT 0 nDRIVE SELECT 2
The DS2 disk interface is not supported.
(Always 1)
BIT 1 nDRIVE SELECT 3
The DS3 disk interface is not supported.
(Always 1)
BIT 2 WRITE GATE
Active high status of the latched WGATE output
signal. This bit is latched by the active going
edge of WGATE and is cleared by the read of
the DIR register.
BIT 3 READ DATA
Active high status of the latched RDATA output
signal. This bit is latched by the inactive going
edge of RDATA and is cleared by the read of the
DIR register.
BIT 4 WRITE DATA
Active high status of the latched WDATA output
signal. This bit is latched by the inactive going
edge of WDATA and is cleared by the read of
the DIR register. This bit is not gated with
WGATE.
BIT 5 nDRIVE SELECT 0
Active low status of the DS0 disk interface
output.
BIT 6 nDRIVE SELECT 1
Active low status of the DS1 disk interface
output.
BIT 7 nDRV2
Active low status of the DRV2 disk interface
input, this is not supported. (Always 1).
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
nDRV2
nDS1
nDS0
WDATA
F/F
RDATA
F/F
WGATE
F/F
nDS3
nDS2
RESET
COND.
N/A
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
20
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER (DOR)
Address 3F2 READ/WRITE
The DOR controls the drive select and motor
enables of the disk interface outputs. It also
contains the enable for the DMA logic and a
software reset bit. The contents of the DOR are
unaffected by a software reset. The DOR can
be written to at any time.
BIT 0 and 1 DRIVE SELECT
These two bits are binary encoded for the drive
selects, thereby allowing only one drive to be
selected at one time.
BIT 2 nRESET
A logic "0" written to this bit resets the Floppy
disk controller. This reset will remain active
until a logic "1" is written to this bit. This
software reset does not affect the DSR and CCR
registers, nor does it affect the other bits of the
DOR register. The minimum reset duration
required is 100ns, therefore toggling this bit by
consecutive writes to this register is a valid
method of issuing a software reset.
BIT 3 DMAEN
PC/AT and Model 30 Mode:
Writing this bit to logic "1" will enable the DRQ,
nDACK, TC and FINTR outputs. This bit being
a logic "0" will disable the nDACK and TC
inputs, and hold the DRQ and FINTR outputs in
a high impedance state. This bit is a logic "0"
after a reset and in these modes.
PS/2 Mode: In this mode the DRQ, nDACK, TC
and FINTR pins are always enabled. During a
reset, the DRQ, nDACK, TC, and FINTR pins
will remain enabled, but this bit will be cleared to
a logic "0".
BIT 4 MOTOR ENABLE 0
This bit controls the MTR0 disk interface output.
A logic "1" in this bit will cause the output pin to
go active.
BIT 5 MOTOR ENABLE 1
This bit controls the MTR1 disk interface output.
A logic "1" in this bit will cause the output pin to
go active.
BIT 6 MOTOR ENABLE 2
The MTR2 disk interface output is not. (Always
0)
BIT 7 MOTOR ENABLE 3
The MTR3 disk interface output is not. (Always
0)
TABLE 6 - DRIVE ACTIVATION VALUES
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MOT
EN3
MOT
EN2
MOT
EN1
MOT
EN0
DMAEN nRESE
T
DRIVE
SEL1
DRIVE
SEL0
RESET
COND.
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DRIVE
DOR VALUE
0
1
1CH
2DH
21
TAPE DRIVE REGISTER (TDR)
Address 3F3 READ/WRITE
TABLE 7 - TAPE SELECT BITS
The Tape Drive Register (TDR) is included for
82077 software compatibility and allows the
user to assign tape support to a particular drive
during initialization. Any future references to
that drive automatically invokes tape support.
The TDR Tape Select bits TDR.[1:0] determine
the tape drive number. TABLE 7 illustrates the
Tape Select Bit encoding. Note that drive 0 is
the boot device and cannot be assigned tape
support. The remaining Tape Drive Register
bits TDR.[7:2] are tristated when read. The TDR
is unaffected by a software reset.
TABLE 8 - INTERNAL 2 DRIVE DECODE - NORMAL
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
DRIVE SELECT
OUTPUTS (ACTIVE LOW)
MOTOR ON OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit1
Bit 0
nDS1
nDS0
nMTR1
nMTR0
X
X
X
1
0
0
1
0
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
X
X
1
X
0
1
0
1
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
X
1
X
X
1
0
1
1
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
1
X
X
X
1
1
1
1
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
0
0
0
0
X
X
1
1
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
TABLE 9 - INTERNAL 2 DRIVE DECODE - DRIVES 0 AND 1 SWAPPED
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
DRIVE SELECT OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
MOTOR ON OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit1
Bit 0
nDS1
nDS0
nMTR1
nMTR0
X
X
X
1
0
0
0
1
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
X
X
1
X
0
1
1
0
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
X
1
X
X
1
0
1
1
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
1
X
X
X
1
1
1
1
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
0
0
0
0
X
X
1
1
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
TAPE SEL1
(TDR.1)
TAPE SEL0
(TDR.0)
DRIVE
SELECTED
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
None
1
2
3
22
Normal Floppy Mode
Normal mode. Register 3F3 contains only bits 0 and 1. When this register is read, bits 2 - 7 are a
high impedance.
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
REG 3F3
Tri-state
Tri-state
Tri-state
Tri-state
Tri-state
Tri-state
tape sel1
tape sel0
Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 (OS2)
Register 3F3 for Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 operation.
DB7
DB6
DB5
DB4
DB3
DB2
DB1
DB0
REG 3F3 Reserved Reserved
Drive Type ID
Floppy Boot Drive
tape sel1
tape sel0
TABLE 10 - DRIVE TYPE ID
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
REGISTER 3F3 - DRIVE TYPE ID
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bit 5
Bit 4
0
0
L0-CRF2 - B1
L0-CRF2 - B0
0
1
L0-CRF2 - B3
L0-CRF2 - B2
1
0
L0-CRF2 - B5
L0-CRF2 - B4
1
1
L0-CRF2 - B7
L0-CRF2 - B6
Note:L0-CRF2-Bx = Logical Device 0, Configuration Register F2, Bit x.
23
DATA RATE SELECT REGISTER (DSR)
Address 3F4 WRITE ONLY
This register is write only. It is used to program
the data rate, amount of write precompensation,
power down status, and software reset. The
data rate is programmed using the
Configuration Control Register (CCR) not the
DSR, for PC/AT and PS/2 Model 30 and
Microchannel applications. Other applications
can set the data rate in the DSR. The data rate
of the floppy controller is the most recent write
of either the DSR or CCR. The DSR is
unaffected by a software reset. A hardware
reset will set the DSR to 02H, which
corresponds to the default precompensation
setting and 250 Kbps.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
S/W
RESET
POWER
DOWN
0
PRE-
COMP2
PRE-
COMP1
PRE-
COMP0
DRATE
SEL1
DRATE
SEL0
RESET
COND.
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy
controller. See Table 11 for the settings
corresponding to the individual data rates. The
data rate select bits are unaffected by a
software reset, and are set to 250 Kbps after a
hardware reset.
BIT 2 through 4 PRECOMPENSATION
SELECT
These three bits select the value of write
precompensation that will be applied to the
WDATA output signal. Table 10 shows the
precompensation values for the combination of
these bits settings. Track 0 is the default
starting track number to start precompensation.
this starting track number can be changed by
the configure command.
BIT 5 UNDEFINED
Should be written as a logic "0".
BIT 6 LOW POWER
A logic "1" written to this bit will put the floppy
controller into manual low power mode. The
floppy controller clock and data mode after a
software reset or access to the Data Register or
Main Status Register.
BIT 7 SOFTWARE RESET
This active high bit has the same function as the
DOR RESET (DOR bit 2) except that this bit is
self clearing.
Note: The DSR is Shadowed in the Floppy Data
Rate Select Shadow Register, LD8:CRC2[7:0].
separator circuits will be turned off. The
controller will come out of manual low power.
24
TABLE 11 - PRECOMPENSATION DELAYS
PRECOMP
432
PRECOMPENSATION
DELAY (nsec)
<2Mbps
2Mbps
111
001
010
011
100
101
110
000
0.00
41.67
83.34
125.00
166.67
208.33
250.00
Default
0
20.8
41.7
62.5
83.3
104.2
125
Default
Default: See Table 11
TABLE 12 - DATA RATES
DRIVE RATE
DATA RATE
DATA RATE
DENSEL
DRATE(1)
DRT1
DRT0
SEL1
SEL0
MFM
FM
1
0
0
0
1
1
1Meg
---
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
500
250
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
300
150
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
250
125
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1Meg
---
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
500
250
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
500
250
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
250
125
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1Meg
---
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
500
250
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
2Meg
---
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
250
125
0
1
0
Drive Rate Table (Recommended)00 = 360K, 1.2M, 720K, 1.44M and 2.88M Vertical Format
01 = 3-Mode Drive
10 = 2 Meg Tape
Note 1:The DRATE and DENSEL values are mapped onto the DRVDEN pins.
25
TABLE 13 - DRVDEN MAPPING
DT1
DT0
DRVDEN1 (1)
DRVDEN0 (1)
DRIVE TYPE
0
0
DRATE0
DENSEL
4/2/1 MB 3.5"
2/1 MB 5.25" FDDS
2/1.6/1 MB 3.5" (3-MODE)
1
0
DRATE0
DRATE1
0
1
DRATE0
nDENSEL
PS/2
1
1
DRATE1
DRATE0
TABLE 14 - DEFAULT PRECOMPENSATION DELAYS
DATA RATE
PRECOMPENSATION
DELAYS
2 Mbps
1 Mbps
500 Kbps
300 Kbps
250 Kbps
20.8 ns
41.67 ns
125 ns
125 ns
125 ns
26
MAIN STATUS REGISTER
Address 3F4 READ ONLY
The Main Status Register is a read-only register
and indicates the status of the disk controller.
The Main Status Register can be read at any
time. The MSR indicates when the disk
controller is ready to receive data via the Data
Register. It should be read before each byte
transferring to or from the data register except in
DMA mode. No delay is required when reading
the MSR after a data transfer.
BIT 0 - 1 DRV x BUSY
These bits are set to 1s when a drive is in the
seek portion of a command, including implied
and overlapped seeks and recalibrates.
BIT 4 COMMAND BUSY
This bit is set to a 1 when a command is in
progress. This bit will go active after the
command byte has been accepted and goes
inactive at the end of the results phase. If there
is no result phase (Seek, Recalibrate
commands), this bit is returned to a 0 after the
last command byte.
BIT 5 NON-DMA
This mode is selected in the SPECIFY
command and will be set to a 1 during the
execution phase of a command. This is for
polled data transfers and helps differentiate
between the data transfer phase and the reading
of result bytes.
BIT 6 DIO
Indicates the direction of a data transfer once a
RQM is set. A 1 indicates a read and a 0
indicates a write is required.
BIT 7 RQM
Indicates that the host can transfer data if set to
a 1. No access is permitted if set to a 0.
DATA REGISTER (FIFO)
Address 3F5 READ/WRITE
All command parameter information, disk data
and result status are transferred between the
host processor and the floppy disk controller
through the Data Register.
Data transfers are governed by the RQM and
DIO bits in the Main Status Register.
The Data Register defaults to FIFO disabled
mode after any form of reset. This maintains
PC/AT hardware compatibility. The default
values can be changed through the Configure
command (enable full FIFO operation with
threshold control). The advantage of the FIFO
is that it allows the system a larger DMA latency
without causing a disk error. Table 14 gives
several examples of the delays with a FIFO.
The data is based upon the following formula:
Threshold # x
1
DATA RATE
x 8
- 1.5 s = DELAY
At the start of a command, the FIFO action is
always disabled and command parameters
must be sent based upon the RQM and DIO bit
settings. As the command execution phase is
entered, the FIFO is cleared of any data to
ensure that invalid data is not transferred.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RQM
DIO
NON
DMA
CMD
BUSY
Reserved Reserved
DRV1
BUSY
DRV0
BUSY
27
An overrun or underrun will terminate the
current command and the transfer of data. Disk
writes will complete the current sector by
generating a 00 pattern and valid CRC. Reads
require the host to remove the remaining data
so that the result phase may be entered.
TABLE 15 - FIFO SERVICE DELAY
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING
AT 2 Mbps DATA RATE
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
1 x 4
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 2.5
µ
s
2 x 4
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 6.5
µ
s
8 x 4
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 30.5
µ
s
15 x 4
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 58.5
µ
s
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING
AT 1 Mbps DATA RATE
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
1 x 8
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 6.5
µ
s
2 x 8
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 14.5
µ
s
8 x 8
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 62.5
µ
s
15 x 8
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 118.5
µ
s
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING
AT 500 Kbps DATA RATE
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
1 x 16
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 14.5
µ
s
2 x 16
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 30.5
µ
s
8 x 16
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 126.5
µ
s
15 x 16
µ
s - 1.5
µ
s = 238.5
µ
s
28
DIGITAL INPUT REGISTER (DIR)
Address 3F7 READ ONLY
This register is read-only in all modes.
PC-AT Mode
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DSK
CHG
RESET
COND.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
BIT 0 - 6 UNDEFINED
The data bus outputs D0 - 6 will remain in a
high impedance state during a read of this
register.
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and
reflects the opposite value seen on the disk
cable or the value programmed in the Force
Disk Change Register (see Configuration
Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
PS/2 Mode
BIT 0 nHIGH DENS
This bit is low whenever the 500 Kbps or 1 Mbps
data rates are selected, and high when 250
Kbps and 300 Kbps are selected.
BITS 1 - 2 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy
controller. See Table 11 for the settings
corresponding to the individual data rates. The
data rate select bits are unaffected by a
software reset, and are set to 250 Kbps after a
hardware reset.
BITS 3 - 6 UNDEFINED
Always read as a logic "1"
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and
reflects the opposite value seen on the disk
cable or the value programmed in the Force
Disk Change Register (see Configuration
Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DSK
CHG
1
1
1
1
DRATE
SEL1
DRATE
SEL0
nHIGH
nDENS
RESET
COND.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
29
Model 30 Mode
BITS 0 - 1 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy
controller. See Table 11 for the settings
corresponding to the individual data rates. The
data rate select bits are unaffected by a
software reset, and are set to 250 Kbps after a
hardware reset.
BIT 2 NOPREC
This bit reflects the value of NOPREC bit set in
the CCR register.
BIT 3 DMAEN
This bit reflects the value of DMAEN bit set in
the DOR register bit 3.
BITS 4 - 6 UNDEFINED
Always read as a logic "0"
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and
reflects the opposite value seen on the disk
cable or the value programmed in the Force
Disk Change Register (see Configuration
Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DSK
CHG
0
0
0
DMAEN NOPREC DRATE
SEL1
DRATE
SEL0
RESET
COND.
N/A
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
30
CONFIGURATION CONTROL REGISTER (CCR)
Address 3F7 WRITE ONLY
PC/AT and PS/2 Modes
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT 0 and 1
These bits determine the data rate of the floppy
controller. See Table 11 for the appropriate
values.
BIT 2 - 7 RESERVED
Should be set to a logical "0"
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT 0 and 1
These bits determine the data rate of the floppy
controller. See Table 11 for the appropriate
values.
BIT 2 NO PRECOMPENSATION
This bit can be set by software, but it has no
functionality. It can be read by bit 2 of the DSR
when in Model 30 register mode. Unaffected by
software reset.
BIT 3 - 7 RESERVED
Should be set to a logical "0"
Table 12 shows the state of the DENSEL pin.
The DENSEL pin is set high after a hardware
reset and is unaffected by the DOR and the
DSR resets.
STATUS REGISTER ENCODING
During the Result Phase of certain commands,
the Data Register contains data bytes that give
the status of the command just executed.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DRATE
SEL1
DRATE
SEL0
RESET
COND.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
NOPREC DRATE
SEL1
DRATE
SEL0
RESET
COND.
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
0
31
TABLE 16 - STATUS REGISTER 0
BIT NO.
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
7,6
IC
Interrupt
Code
00 - Normal termination of command. The specified
command was properly executed and completed
without error.
01 - Abnormal termination of command. Command
execution was started, but was not successfully
completed.
10 - Invalid command. The requested command
could not be executed.
11 - Abnormal termination caused by Polling.
5
SE
Seek End
The FDC completed a Seek, Relative Seek or
Recalibrate command (used during a Sense Interrupt
Command).
4
EC
Equipment
Check
The TRK0 pin failed to become a "1" after:
1.
80 step pulses in the Recalibrate command.
2.
The Relative Seek command caused the FDC to
step outward beyond Track 0.
3
Unused. This bit is always "0".
2
H
Head
Address
The current head address.
1,0
DS1,0
Drive Select
The current selected drive.
32
TABLE 17 - STATUS REGISTER 1
BIT NO.
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
7
EN
End of
Cylinder
The FDC tried to access a sector beyond the final
sector of the track (255D). Will be set if TC is not
issued after Read or Write Data command.
6
Unused. This bit is always "0".
5
DE
Data Error
The FDC detected a CRC error in either the ID field or
the data field of a sector.
4
OR
Overrun/
Underrun
Becomes set if the FDC does not receive CPU or DMA
service within the required time interval, resulting in
data overrun or underrun.
3
Unused. This bit is always "0".
2
ND
No Data
Any one of the following:
1. Read Data, Read Deleted Data command - the
FDC did not find the specified sector.
2. Read ID command - the FDC cannot read the ID
field without an error.
3. Read A Track command - the FDC cannot find the
proper sector sequence.
1
NW
Not Writeable WP pin became a "1" while the FDC is executing a
Write Data, Write Deleted Data, or Format A Track
command.
0
MA
Missing
Address Mark
Any one of the following:
1. The FDC did not detect an ID address mark at the
specified track after encountering the index pulse from
the IDX pin twice.
2. The FDC cannot detect a data address mark or a
deleted data address mark on the specified track.
33
TABLE 18 - STATUS REGISTER 2
BIT NO.
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
7
Unused. This bit is always "0".
6
CM
Control Mark
Any one of the following:
1. Read Data command - the FDC encountered a
deleted data address mark.
2. Read Deleted Data command - the FDC
encountered a data address mark.
5
DD
Data Error in
Data Field
The FDC detected a CRC error in the data field.
4
WC
Wrong
Cylinder
The track address from the sector ID field is different
from the track address maintained inside the FDC.
3
Unused. This bit is always "0".
2
Unused. This bit is always "0".
1
BC
Bad Cylinder
The track address from the sector ID field is different
from the track address maintained inside the FDC and
is equal to FF hex, which indicates a bad track with a
hard error according to the IBM soft-sectored format.
0
MD
Missing Data
Address Mark
The FDC cannot detect a data address mark or a
deleted data address mark.
TABLE 19 - STATUS REGISTER 3
BIT NO.
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
7
Unused. This bit is always "0".
6
WP
Write
Protected
Indicates the status of the WP pin.
5
Unused. This bit is always "1".
4
T0
Track 0
Indicates the status of the TRK0 pin.
3
Unused. This bit is always "1".
2
HD
Head
Address
Indicates the status of the HDSEL pin.
1,0
DS1,0
Drive Select
Indicates the status of the DS1, DS0 pins.
34
RESET
There are three sources of system reset on the
FDC: the RESET pin of the FDC, a reset
generated via a bit in the DOR, and a reset
generated via a bit in the DSR. At power on, a
Power On Reset initializes the FDC. All resets
take the FDC out of the power down state.
All operations are terminated upon a RESET,
and the FDC enters an idle state. A reset while
a disk write is in progress will corrupt the data
and CRC.
On exiting the reset state, various internal
registers are cleared, including the Configure
command information, and the FDC waits for a
new command. Drive polling will start unless
disabled by a new Configure command.
RESET Pin (Hardware Reset)
The RESET pin is a global reset and clears all
registers except those programmed by the
Specify command. The DOR reset bit is
enabled and must be cleared by the host to exit
the reset state.
DOR Reset vs. DSR Reset (Software Reset)
These two resets are functionally the same.
Both will reset the FDC core, which affects drive
status information and the FIFO circuits. The
DSR reset clears itself automatically while the
DOR reset requires the host to manually clear it.
DOR reset has precedence over the DSR reset.
The DOR reset is set automatically upon a pin
reset. The user must manually clear this reset
bit in the DOR to exit the reset state.
MODES OF OPERATION
The FDC has three modes of operation, PC/AT
mode, PS/2 mode and Model 30 mode. These
are determined by the state of the IDENT and
MFM bits 3 and 2 respectively of LD8CRF0.
PC/AT mode - (IDENT high, MFM a "don't
care")
The PC/AT register set is enabled, the DMA
enable bit of the DOR becomes valid (FINTR
and DRQ can be hi Z), and TC and DENSEL
become active high signals.
PS/2 mode - (IDENT low, MFM high)
This mode supports the PS/2 models 50/60/80
configuration and register set. The DMA bit of
the DOR becomes a "don't care", (FINTR and
DRQ are always valid), TC and DENSEL
become active low.
Model 30 mode - (IDENT low, MFM low)
This mode supports PS/2 Model 30
configuration and register set. The DMA enable
bit of the DOR becomes valid (FINTR and DRQ
can be hi Z), TC is active high and DENSEL is
active low.
DMA TRANSFERS
DMA transfers are enabled with the Specify
command and are initiated by the FDC by
activating the FDRQ pin during a data transfer
command. The FIFO is enabled directly by
asserting nDACK and addresses need not be
valid.
Note that if the DMA controller (i.e. 8237A) is
programmed to function in verify mode, a
pseudo read is performed by the FDC based
only on nDACK. This mode is only available
when the FDC has been configured into byte
mode (FIFO disabled) and is programmed to do
a read. With the FIFO enabled, the FDC can
perform the above operation by using the new
Verify command; no DMA operation is needed.
Two DMA transfer modes are supported for the
FDC: Single Transfer and Burst Transfer. In the
case of the single transfer, the DMA Req goes
active at the start of the DMA cycle, and the
DMA Req is deasserted after the nDACK. In the
case of the burst transfer, the Req is held active
35
until the last transfer (independent of nDACK).
See timing diagrams for more information.
Burst mode is enabled via Bit[1] of CRF0 in
Logical Device 0. Setting Bit[1]=0 enables burst
mode; the default is Bit[1]=1, for non-burst
mode.
CONTROLLER PHASES
For simplicity, command handling in the FDC
can be divided into three phases: Command,
Execution, and Result. Each phase is described
in the following sections.
Command Phase
After a reset, the FDC enters the command
phase and is ready to accept a command from
the host. For each of the commands, a defined
set of command code bytes and parameter
bytes has to be written to the FDC before the
command phase is complete. (Please refer to
TABLE 20 for the command set descriptions).
These bytes of data must be transferred in the
order prescribed.
Before writing to the FDC, the host must
examine the RQM and DIO bits of the Main
Status Register. RQM and DIO must be equal
to "1" and "0" respectively before command
bytes may be written. RQM is set false by the
FDC after each write cycle until the received
byte is processed. The FDC asserts RQM again
to request each parameter byte of the command
unless an illegal command condition is
detected. After the last parameter byte is
received, RQM remains "0" and the FDC
automatically enters the next phase as defined
by the command definition.
The FIFO is disabled during the command
phase to provide for the proper handling of the
"Invalid Command" condition.
Execution Phase
All data transfers to or from the FDC occur
during the execution phase, which can proceed
in DMA or non-DMA mode as indicated in the
Specify command.
After a reset, the FIFO is disabled. Each data
byte is transferred by an FINT or FDRQ
depending on the DMA mode. The Configure
command can enable the FIFO and set the
FIFO threshold value.
The following paragraphs detail the operation of
the FIFO flow control. In these descriptions,
<threshold> is defined as the number of bytes
available to the FDC when service is requested
from the host and ranges from 1 to 16. The
parameter FIFOTHR, which the user programs,
is one less and ranges from 0 to 15.
A low threshold value (i.e. 2) results in longer
periods of time between service requests, but
requires faster servicing of the request for both
read and write cases. The host reads (writes)
from (to) the FIFO until empty (full), then the
transfer request goes inactive. The host must
be very responsive to the service request. This
is the desired case for use with a "fast" system.
A high value of threshold (i.e. 12) is used with a
"sluggish" system by affording a long latency
period after a service request, but results in
more frequent service requests.
Non-DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to
the Host
The FINT pin and RQM bits in the Main Status
Register are activated when the FIFO contains
(16-<threshold>) bytes or the last bytes of a full
sector have been placed in the FIFO. The FINT
pin can be used for interrupt-driven systems,
and RQM can be used for polled systems. The
host must respond to the request by reading
data from the FIFO. This process is repeated
until the last byte is transferred out of the FIFO.
36
The FDC will deactivate the FINT pin and RQM
bit when the FIFO becomes empty.
Non-DMA Mode - Transfers from the Host to the
FIFO
The FINT pin and RQM bit in the Main Status
Register are activated upon entering the
execution phase of data transfer commands.
The host must respond to the request by writing
data into the FIFO. The FINT pin and RQM bit
remain true until the FIFO becomes full. They
are set true again when the FIFO has
<threshold> bytes remaining in the FIFO. The
FINT pin will also be deactivated if TC and
nDACK both go inactive. The FDC enters the
result phase after the last byte is taken by the
FDC from the FIFO (i.e. FIFO empty condition).
DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to the
Host
The FDC activates the DDRQ pin when the
FIFO contains (16 - <threshold>) bytes, or the
last byte of a full sector transfer has been
placed in the FIFO. The DMA controller must
respond to the request by reading data from the
FIFO. The FDC will deactivate the DDRQ pin
when the FIFO becomes empty. FDRQ goes
inactive after nDACK goes active for the last
byte of a data transfer (or on the active edge of
nIOR, on the last byte, if no edge is present on
nDACK). A data underrun may occur if FDRQ
is not removed in time to prevent an unwanted
cycle.
DMA Mode - Transfers from the Host to the
FIFO.
The FDC activates the FDRQ pin when entering
the execution phase of the data transfer
commands. The DMA controller must respond
by activating the nDACK and nIOW pins and
placing data in the FIFO. FDRQ remains active
until the FIFO becomes full. FDRQ is again set
true when the FIFO has <threshold> bytes
remaining in the FIFO. The FDC will also
deactivate the FDRQ pin when TC becomes true
(qualified by nDACK), indicating that no more
data is required. FDRQ goes inactive after
nDACK goes active for the last byte of a data
transfer (or on the active edge of nIOW of the
last byte, if no edge is present on nDACK). A
data overrun may occur if FDRQ is not removed
in time to prevent an unwanted cycle.
Data Transfer Termination
The FDC supports terminal count explicitly
through the TC pin and implicitly through the
underrun/overrun and end-of-track (EOT)
functions. For full sector transfers, the EOT
parameter can define the last sector to be
transferred in a single or multi-sector transfer.
If the last sector to be transferred is a partial
sector, the host can stop transferring the data in
mid-sector, and the FDC will continue to
complete the sector as if a hardware TC was
received. The only difference between these
implicit functions and TC is that they return
"abnormal termination" result status. Such
status indications can be ignored if they were
expected.
Note that when the host is sending data to the
FIFO of the FDC, the internal sector count will
be complete when the FDC reads the last byte
from its side of the FIFO. There may be a delay
in the removal of the transfer request signal of
up to the time taken for the FDC to read the last
16 bytes from the FIFO. The host must tolerate
this delay.
37
Result Phase
The generation of FINT determines the
beginning of the result phase. For each of the
commands, a defined set of result bytes has to
be read from the FDC before the result phase is
complete. These bytes of data must be read out
for another command to start.
RQM and DIO must both equal "1" before the
result bytes may be read. After all the result
bytes have been read, the RQM and DIO bits
switch to "1" and "0" respectively, and the CB bit
is cleared, indicating that the FDC is ready to
accept the next command.
38
COMMAND SET/DESCRIPTIONS
Commands can be written whenever the FDC is
in the command phase. Each command has a
unique set of needed parameters and status
results. The FDC checks to see that the first
byte is a valid command and, if valid, proceeds
with the command. If it is invalid, an interrupt is
issued. The user sends a Sense Interrupt
Status command which returns an invalid
command error. Refer to TABLE 20 for
explanations of the various symbols used.
TABLE 21 lists the required parameters and the
results associated with each command that the
FDC is capable of performing.
TABLE 20 - DESCRIPTION OF COMMAND SYMBOLS
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
C
Cylinder Address
The currently selected address; 0 to 255.
D
Data Pattern
The pattern to be written in each sector data field during
formatting.
D0, D1
Drive Select 0-1
Designates which drives are perpendicular drives on the
Perpendicular Mode Command. A "1" indicates a perpendicular
drive.
DIR
Direction Control
If this bit is 0, then the head will step out from the spindle during a
relative seek. If set to a 1, the head will step in toward the spindle.
DS0, DS1
Disk Drive Select
DS1 DS0 Drive Selected
0 0 Drive 0
0 1 Drive 1
DTL
Special Sector
Size
By setting N to zero (00), DTL may be used to control the number
of bytes transferred in disk read/write commands. The sector size
(N = 0) is set to 128. If the actual sector (on the diskette) is larger
than DTL, the remainder of the actual sector is read but is not
passed to the host during read commands; during write
commands, the remainder of the actual sector is written with all
zero bytes. The CRC check code is calculated with the actual
sector. When N is not zero, DTL has no meaning and should be
set to FF HEX.
EC
Enable Count
When this bit is "1" the "DTL" parameter of the Verify command
becomes SC (number of sectors per track).
EFIFO
Enable FIFO
This active low bit when a 0, enables the FIFO. A "1" disables the
FIFO (default).
EIS
Enable Implied
Seek
When set, a seek operation will be performed before executing any
read or write command that requires the C parameter in the
command phase. A "0" disables the implied seek.
EOT
End of Track
The final sector number of the current track.
GAP
Alters Gap 2 length when using Perpendicular Mode.
GPL
Gap Length
The Gap 3 size. (Gap 3 is the space between sectors excluding
the VCO synchronization field).
H/HDS
Head Address
Selected head: 0 or 1 (disk side 0 or 1) as encoded in the sector
ID field.
39
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
HLT
Head Load Time
The time interval that FDC waits after loading the head and before
initializing a read or write operation. Refer to the Specify
command for actual delays.
HUT
Head Unload
Time
The time interval from the end of the execution phase (of a read or
write command) until the head is unloaded. Refer to the Specify
command for actual delays.
LOCK
Lock defines whether EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK parameters
of the CONFIGURE COMMAND can be reset to their default
values by a "software Reset". (A reset caused by writing to the
appropriate bits of either the DSR or DOR)
MFM
MFM/FM Mode
Selector
A one selects the double density (MFM) mode. A zero selects
single density (FM) mode.
MT
Multi-Track
Selector
When set, this flag selects the multi-track operating mode. In this
mode, the FDC treats a complete cylinder under head 0 and 1 as
a single track. The FDC operates as this expanded track started
at the first sector under head 0 and ended at the last sector under
head 1. With this flag set, a multitrack read or write operation will
automatically continue to the first sector under head 1 when the
FDC finishes operating on the last sector under head 0.
N
Sector Size Code
This specifies the number of bytes in a sector. If this parameter is
"00", then the sector size is 128 bytes. The number of bytes
transferred is determined by the DTL parameter. Otherwise the
sector size is (2 raised to the "N'th" power) times 128. All values
up to "07" hex are allowable. "07"h would equal a sector size of
16k. It is the user's responsibility to not select combinations that
are not possible with the drive.
N Sector Size
0 128 Bytes
1 256 Bytes
2 512 Bytes
3 1024 Bytes
... ...
NCN
New Cylinder
Number
The desired cylinder number.
ND
Non-DMA Mode
Flag
When set to 1, indicates that the FDC is to operate in the non-
DMA mode. In this mode, the host is interrupted for each data
transfer. When set to 0, the FDC operates in DMA mode,
interfacing to a DMA controller by means of the DRQ and nDACK
signals.
OW
Overwrite
The bits D0-D3 of the Perpendicular Mode Command can only be
modified if OW is set to 1. OW id defined in the Lock command.
PCN
Present Cylinder
Number
The current position of the head at the completion of Sense
Interrupt Status command.
POLL
Polling Disable
When set, the internal polling routine is disabled. When clear,
polling is enabled.
40
SYMBOL
NAME
DESCRIPTION
PRETRK
Precompensation
Start Track
Number
Programmable from track 00 to FFH.
R
Sector Address
The sector number to be read or written. In multi-sector transfers,
this parameter specifies the sector number of the first sector to be
read or written.
RCN
Relative Cylinder
Number
Relative cylinder offset from present cylinder as used by the
Relative Seek command.
SC
Number of
Sectors Per Track
The number of sectors per track to be initialized by the Format
command. The number of sectors per track to be verified during a
Verify command when EC is set.
SK
Skip Flag
When set to 1, sectors containing a deleted data address mark will
automatically be skipped during the execution of Read Data. If
Read Deleted is executed, only sectors with a deleted address
mark will be accessed. When set to "0", the sector is read or
written the same as the read and write commands.
SRT
Step Rate Interval The time interval between step pulses issued by the FDC.
Programmable from 0.5 to 8 milliseconds in increments of 0.5 ms
at the 1 Mbit data rate. Refer to the SPECIFY command for actual
delays.
ST0
ST1
ST2
ST3
Status 0
Status 1
Status 2
Status 3
Registers within the FDC which store status information after a
command has been executed. This status information is available
to the host during the result phase after command execution.
WGATE
Write Gate
Alters timing of WE to allow for pre-erase loads in perpendicular
drives.
41
INSTRUCTION SET
TABLE 21 - INSTRUCTION SET
READ DATA
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
MT
MFM
SK
0
0
1
1
0
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information prior to
Command execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------- DTL -------
Execution
Data transfer between the
FDD and system.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
42
READ DELETED DATA
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
MT
MFM
SK
0
1
1
0
0
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information prior to
Command execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------- DTL -------
Execution
Data transfer between the
FDD and system.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
43
WRITE DATA
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
MT
MFM
0
0
0
1
0
1
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information prior to
Command execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------- DTL -------
Execution
Data transfer between the
FDD and system.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
44
WRITE DELETED DATA
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
MT
MFM
0
0
1
0
0
1
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
prior to Command
execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------- DTL -------
Execution
Data transfer between
the FDD and system.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
after Command
execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
45
READ A TRACK
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
MFM
0
0
0
0
1
0
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
prior to Command
execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------- DTL -------
Execution
Data transfer between
the FDD and system.
FDC reads all of
cylinders' contents from
index hole to EOT.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
after Command
execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
46
VERIFY
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
MT
MFM
SK
1
0
1
1
0
Command Codes
W
EC
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
prior to Command
execution.
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
W
------- EOT -------
W
------- GPL -------
W
------ DTL/SC ------
Execution
No data transfer takes
place.
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution.
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
-------- C --------
Sector ID information
after Command
execution.
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
VERSION
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
Command Code
Result
R
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
Enhanced Controller
47
FORMAT A TRACK
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
MFM
0
0
1
1
0
1
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
-------- N --------
Bytes/Sector
W
-------- SC --------
Sectors/Cylinder
W
------- GPL -------
Gap 3
W
-------- D --------
Filler Byte
Execution for
Each Sector
Repeat:
W
-------- C --------
Input Sector
Parameters
W
-------- H --------
W
-------- R --------
W
-------- N --------
FDC formats an entire
cylinder
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information after
Command execution
R
------- ST1 -------
R
------- ST2 -------
R
------ Undefined ------
R
------ Undefined ------
R
------ Undefined ------
R
------ Undefined ------
48
RECALIBRATE
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
DS1
DS0
Execution
Head retracted to Track 0
Interrupt.
SENSE INTERRUPT STATUS
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
Command Codes
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
Status information at the end
of each seek operation.
R
------- PCN -------
SPECIFY
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
Command Codes
W
--- SRT ---
--- HUT ---
W
------ HLT ------
ND
49
SENSE DRIVE STATUS
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
Result
R
------- ST3 -------
Status information about
FDD
SEEK
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Command Codes
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
------- NCN -------
Execution
Head positioned over
proper cylinder on
diskette.
CONFIGURE
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
Configure
Information
W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
W
0
EIS EFIFO
POLL
--- FIFOTHR ---
Execution
W
--------- PRETRK ---------
50
RELATIVE SEEK
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
1
DIR
0
0
1
1
1
1
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
W
------- RCN -------
DUMPREG
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
*Note:
Registers
placed in
FIFO
Execution
Result
R
------ PCN-Drive 0 -------
R
------ PCN-Drive 1 -------
R
------ PCN-Drive 2 -------
R
------ PCN-Drive 3 -------
R
---- SRT ----
--- HUT ---
R
------- HLT -------
ND
R
------- SC/EOT -------
R
LOCK
0
D3
D2
D1
D0
GAP
WGATE
R
0
EIS EFIFO
POLL
-- FIFOTHR --
R
-------- PRETRK --------
51
READ ID
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
MFM
0
0
1
0
1
0
Commands
W
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
DS0
Execution
The first correct ID
information on the
Cylinder is stored in
Data Register
Result
R
-------- ST0 --------
Status information after
Command execution.
Disk status after the
Command has
completed
R
-------- ST1 --------
R
-------- ST2 --------
R
-------- C --------
R
-------- H --------
R
-------- R --------
R
-------- N --------
52
PERPENDICULAR MODE
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
Command Codes
OW
0
D3
D2
D1
D0
GAP
WGATE
INVALID CODES
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
----- Invalid Codes -----
Invalid Command Codes
(NoOp - FDC goes into
Standby State)
Result
R
------- ST0 -------
ST0 = 80H
LOCK
DATA BUS
PHASE
R/W
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
Command
W
LOCK
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
Command Codes
Result
R
0
0
0
LOCK
0
0
0
0
SC is returned if the last command that was issued was the Format command. EOT is returned if the
last command was a Read or Write.
Note: These bits are used internally only. They are not reflected in the Drive Select pins. It is the
user's responsibility to maintain correspondence between these bits and the Drive Select pins (DOR).
53
DATA TRANSFER COMMANDS
All of the Read Data, Write Data and Verify type
commands use the same parameter bytes and
return the same results information, the only
difference being the coding of bits 0-4 in the first
byte.
An implied seek will be executed if the feature
was enabled by the Configure command. This
seek is completely transparent to the user. The
Drive Busy bit for the drive will go active in the
Main Status Register during the seek portion of
the command. If the seek portion fails, it is
reflected in the results status normally returned
for a Read/Write Data command. Status
Register 0 (ST0) would contain the error code
and C would contain the cylinder on which the
seek failed.
Read Data
A set of nine (9) bytes is required to place the
FDC in the Read Data Mode. After the Read
Data command has been issued, the FDC loads
the head (if it is in the unloaded state), waits the
specified head settling time (defined in the
Specify command), and begins reading ID
Address Marks and ID fields. When the sector
address read off the diskette matches with the
sector address specified in the command, the
FDC reads the sector's data field and transfers
the data to the FIFO.
After completion of the read operation from the
current sector, the sector address is
incremented by one and the data from the next
logical sector is read and output via the FIFO.
This continuous read function is called "Multi-
Sector Read Operation". Upon receipt of TC, or
an implied TC (FIFO overrun/underrun), the
FDC stops sending data but will continue to
read data from the current sector, check the
CRC bytes, and at the end of the sector,
terminate the Read Data Command.
N determines the number of bytes per sector
(see Table 21 below). If N is set to zero, the
sector size is set to 128. The DTL value
determines the number of bytes to be
transferred. If DTL is less than 128, the FDC
transfers the specified number of bytes to the
host. For reads, it continues to read the entire
128-byte sector and checks for CRC errors. For
writes, it completes the 128-byte sector by filling
in zeros. If N is not set to 00 Hex, DTL should
be set to FF Hex and has no impact on the
number of bytes transferred.
TABLE 22 - SECTOR SIZES
The amount of data which can be handled with
a single command to the FDC depends upon
MT (multi-track) and N (number of bytes/sector).
The Multi-Track function (MT) allows the FDC to
read data from both sides of the diskette. For a
particular cylinder, data will be transferred
starting at Sector 1, Side 0 and completing the
last sector of the same track at Side 1.
N
SECTOR SIZE
00
01
02
03
..
07
128 bytes
256 bytes
512 bytes
1024 bytes
...
16 Kbytes
54
If the host terminates a read or write operation
in the FDC, the ID information in the result
phase is dependent upon the state of the MT bit
and EOT byte. Refer to Table 20.
At the completion of the Read Data command,
the head is not unloaded until after the Head
Unload Time Interval (specified in the Specify
command) has elapsed. If the host issues
another command before the head unloads,
then the head settling time may be saved
between subsequent reads.
If the FDC detects a pulse on the nINDEX pin
twice without finding the specified sector
(meaning that the diskette's index hole passes
through index detect logic in the drive twice), the
FDC sets the IC code in Status Register 0 to
"01" indicating abnormal termination, sets the
ND bit in Status Register 1 to "1" indicating a
sector not found, and terminates the Read Data
Command.
After reading the ID and Data Fields in each
sector, the FDC checks the CRC bytes. If a
CRC error occurs in the ID or data field, the
FDC sets the IC code in Status Register 0 to
"01" indicating abnormal termination, sets the
DE bit flag in Status Register 1 to "1", sets the
DD bit in Status Register 2 to "1" if CRC is
incorrect in the ID field, and terminates the Read
Data Command. Table 21 describes the effect
of the SK bit on the Read Data command
execution and results. Except where noted in
Table 21, the C or R value of the sector address
is automatically incremented (see Table 23).
TABLE 24 - EFFECTS OF MT AND N BITS
MT
N
MAXIMUM TRANSFER
CAPACITY
FINAL SECTOR READ
FROM DISK
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
2
2
3
3
256 x 26 = 6,656
256 x 52 = 13,312
512 x 15 = 7,680
512 x 30 = 15,360
1024 x 8 = 8,192
1024 x 16 = 16,384
26 at side 0 or 1
26 at side 1
15 at side 0 or 1
15 at side 1
8 at side 0 or 1
16 at side 1
55
TABLE 25 - SKIP BIT VS READ DATA COMMAND
SK BIT
VALUE
DATA ADDRESS
MARK TYPE
ENCOUNTERED
RESULTS
SECTOR
READ?
CM BIT OF
ST2 SET?
DESCRIPTION
OF RESULTS
0
0
1
1
Normal Data
Deleted Data
Normal Data
Deleted Data
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
Normal
termination.
Address not
incremented.
Next sector not
searched for.
Normal
termination.
Normal
termination.
Sector not read
("skipped").
56
Read Deleted Data
This command is the same as the Read Data
command, only it operates on sectors that
contain a Deleted Data Address Mark at the
beginning of a Data Field.
Table 22 describes the effect of the SK bit on
the Read Deleted Data command execution and
results.
Except where noted in Table 22, the C or R
value of the sector address is automatically
incremented (see Table 23).
TABLE 26 - SKIP BIT VS. READ DELETED DATA COMMAND
SK BIT
VALUE
DATA ADDRESS
MARK TYPE
ENCOUNTERED
RESULTS
SECTOR
READ?
CM BIT OF
ST2 SET?
DESCRIPTION
OF RESULTS
0
0
1
1
Normal Data
Deleted Data
Normal Data
Deleted Data
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Address not
incremented.
Next sector not
searched for.
Normal
termination.
Normal
termination.
Sector not read
("skipped").
Normal
termination.
57
Read A Track
This command is similar to the Read Data
command except that the entire data field is
read continuously from each of the sectors of a
track. Immediately after encountering a pulse
on the nINDEX pin, the FDC starts to read all
data fields on the track as continuous blocks of
data without regard to logical sector numbers. If
the FDC finds an error in the ID or DATA CRC
check bytes, it continues to read data from the
track and sets the appropriate error bits at the
end of the command. The FDC compares the
ID information read from each sector with the
specified value in the command and sets the ND
flag of Status Register 1 to a "1" if there is no
comparison. Multi-track or skip operations are
not allowed with this command. The MT and SK
bits (bits D7 and D5 of the first command byte
respectively) should always be set to "0".
This command terminates when the EOT
specified number of sectors has not been read.
If the FDC does not find an ID Address Mark on
the diskette after the second occurrence of a
pulse on the IDX pin, then it sets the IC code in
Status Register 0 to "01" (abnormal
termination), sets the MA bit in Status Register
1 to "1", and terminates the command.
TABLE 27 - RESULT PHASE
MT
HEAD
FINAL SECTOR
TRANSFERRED TO
ID INFORMATION AT RESULT PHASE
HOST
C
H
R
N
0
0
Less than EOT
NC
NC
R + 1
NC
Equal to EOT
C + 1
NC
01
NC
1
Less than EOT
NC
NC
R + 1
NC
Equal to EOT
C + 1
NC
01
NC
1
0
Less than EOT
NC
NC
R + 1
NC
Equal to EOT
NC
LSB
01
NC
1
Less than EOT
NC
NC
R + 1
NC
Equal to EOT
C + 1
LSB
01
NC
NC:
No Change, the same value as the one at the beginning of command execution.
LSB:
Least Significant Bit, the LSB of H is complemented.
58
Write Data
After the Write Data command has been issued,
the FDC loads the head (if it is in the unloaded
state), waits the specified head load time if
unloaded (defined in the Specify command),
and begins reading ID fields. When the sector
address read from the diskette matches the
sector address specified in the command, the
FDC reads the data from the host via the FIFO
and writes it to the sector's data field.
After writing data into the current sector, the
FDC computes the CRC value and writes it into
the CRC field at the end of the sector transfer.
The Sector Number stored in "R" is incremented
by one, and the FDC continues writing to the
next data field. The FDC continues this "Multi-
Sector Write Operation". Upon receipt of a
terminal count signal or if a FIFO over/under run
occurs while a data field is being written, then
the remainder of the data field is filled with
zeros. The FDC reads the ID field of each
sector and checks the CRC bytes. If it detects a
CRC error in one of the ID fields, it sets the IC
code in Status Register
0 to "01" (abnormal termination), sets the DE bit
of Status Register 1 to "1", and terminates the
Write Data command.
The Write Data command operates in much the
same manner as the Read Data command. The
following items are the same. Please refer to the
Read Data Command for details:
·
Transfer Capacity
·
EN (End of Cylinder) bit
·
ND (No Data) bit
·
Head Load, Unload Time Interval
·
ID information when the host terminates the
command
·
Definition of DTL when N = 0 and when N
does not = 0

Write Deleted Data

This command is almost the same as the Write
Data command except that a Deleted Data
Address Mark is written at the beginning of the
Data Field instead of the normal Data Address
Mark. This command is typically used to mark
a bad sector containing an error on the floppy
disk.

Verify

The Verify command is used to verify the data
stored on a disk. This command acts exactly
like a Read Data command except that no data
is transferred to the host. Data is read from the
disk and CRC is computed and checked against
the previously-stored value.

Because data is not transferred to the host, TC
(pin 89) cannot be used to terminate this
command. By setting the EC bit to "1", an
implicit TC will be issued to the FDC. This
implicit TC will occur when the SC value has
decremented to 0 (an SC value of 0 will verify
256 sectors). This command can also be
terminated by setting the EC bit to "0" and the
EOT value equal to the final sector to be
checked. If EC is set to "0", DTL/SC should be
programmed to 0FFH. Refer to Table 23 and
Table 24 for information concerning the values
of MT and EC versus SC and EOT value.

Definitions:
# Sectors Per Side = Number of formatted
sectors per each side of the disk.
# Sectors Remaining = Number of formatted
sectors left which can be read, including side 1
of the disk if MT is set to "1".
59
TABLE 28 - VERIFY COMMAND RESULT PHASE
MT
EC
SC/EOT VALUE
TERMINATION RESULT
0
0
SC = DTL
EOT # Sectors Per Side
Success Termination
Result Phase Valid
0
0
SC = DTL
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
0
1
SC # Sectors Remaining AND
EOT # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
0
1
SC > # Sectors Remaining OR
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
1
0
SC = DTL
EOT # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
1
0
SC = DTL
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
1
1
SC # Sectors Remaining AND
EOT # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
1
1
SC > # Sectors Remaining OR
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
Note: If MT is set to "1" and the SC value is greater than the number of remaining formatted sectors
on Side 0, verifying will continue on Side 1 of the disk.

Format A Track

The Format command allows an entire track to
be formatted. After a pulse from the IDX pin is
detected, the FDC starts writing data on the disk
including gaps, address marks, ID fields, and
data fields per the IBM System 34 or 3740
format (MFM or FM respectively). The particular
values that will be written to the gap and data
field are controlled by the values programmed
into N, SC, GPL, and D which are specified by
the host during the command phase. The data
field of the sector is filled with the data byte
specified by D. The ID field for each sector is
supplied by the host; that is, four data bytes per
sector are needed by the FDC for C, H, R, and
N (cylinder, head, sector number and sector size
respectively).
After formatting each sector, the host must send
new values for C, H, R and N to the FDC for the
next sector on the track. The R value (sector
number) is the only value that must be changed
by the host after each sector is formatted. This
allows the disk to be formatted with
nonsequential sector addresses (interleaving).
This incrementing and formatting continues for
the whole track until the FDC encounters a pulse
on the IDX pin again and it terminates the
command.

Table 29 contains typical values for gap fields
which are dependent upon the size of the sector
and the number of sectors on each track. Actual
values can vary due to drive electronics.
60

FORMAT FIELDS
SYSTEM 34 (DOUBLE DENSITY) FORMAT
GAP4a
80x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IAM
GAP1
50x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S
E
C
N
O
C
R
C
GAP2
22x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
DATA
AM
DATA
C
R
C
GAP3
GAP 4b
3x
C2
FC
3x
A1
FE
3x
A1
FB
F8
SYSTEM 3740 (SINGLE DENSITY) FORMAT
GAP4a
40x
FF
SYNC
6x
00
IAM
GAP1
26x
FF
SYNC
6x
00
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S
E
C
N
O
C
R
C
GAP2
11x
FF
SYNC
6x
00
DATA
AM
DATA
C
R
C
GAP3
GAP 4b
FC
FE
FB or
F8
PERPENDICULAR FORMAT
GAP4a
80x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IAM
GAP1
50x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S
E
C
N
O
C
R
C
GAP2
41x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
DATA
AM
DATA
C
R
C
GAP3
GAP 4b
3x
C2
FC
3x
A1
FE
3x
A1
FB
F8
61
TABLE 29 - TYPICAL VALUES FOR FORMATTING
FORMAT
SECTOR SIZE
N
SC
GPL1
GPL2




5.25"
Drives


FM
128
128
512
1024
2048
4096
...
00
00
02
03
04
05
...
12
10
08
04
02
01
07
10
18
46
C8
C8
09
19
30
87
FF
FF


MFM
256
256
512*
1024
2048
4096
...
01
01
02
03
04
05
...
12
10
09
04
02
01
0A
20
2A
80
C8
C8
0C
32
50
F0
FF
FF
3.5"
Drives
FM
128
256
512
0
1
2
0F
09
05
07
0F
1B
1B
2A
3A
MFM
256
512**
1024
1
2
3
0F
09
05
0E
1B
35
36
54
74
GPL1 = suggested GPL values in Read and Write commands to avoid splice point
between data field and ID field of contiguous sections.
GPL2 = suggested GPL value in Format A Track command.
*PC/AT values (typical)
**PS/2 values (typical). Applies with 1.0 MB and 2.0 MB drives.
NOTE: All values except sector size are in hex.

62
CONTROL COMMANDS

Control commands differ from the other
commands in that no data transfer takes place.
Three commands generate an interrupt when
complete: Read ID, Recalibrate, and Seek. The
other control commands do not generate an
interrupt.

Read ID

The Read ID command is used to find the
present position of the recording heads. The
FDC stores the values from the first ID field it is
able to read into its registers. If the FDC does
not find an ID address mark on the diskette after
the second occurrence of a pulse on the
nINDEX pin, it then sets the IC code in Status
Register 0 to "01" (abnormal termination), sets
the MA bit in Status Register 1 to "1", and
terminates the command.

The following commands will generate an
interrupt upon completion. They do not return
any result bytes. It is highly recommended that
control commands be followed by the Sense
Interrupt Status command. Otherwise, valuable
interrupt status information will be lost.

Recalibrate

This command causes the read/write head
within the FDC to retract to the track 0 position.
The FDC clears the contents of the PCN counter
and checks the status of the nTR0 pin from the
FDD. As long as the nTR0 pin is low, the DIR
pin remains 0 and step pulses are issued.
When the nTR0 pin goes high, the SE bit in
Status Register 0 is set to "1" and the command
is terminated. If the nTR0 pin is still low after 79
step pulses have been issued, the FDC sets the
SE and the EC bits of Status Register 0 to "1"
and terminates the command. Disks capable of
handling more than 80 tracks per side may
require more than one Recalibrate command to
return the head back to physical Track 0.
The Recalibrate command does not have a
result phase. The Sense Interrupt Status
command must be issued after the Recalibrate
command to effectively terminate it and to
provide verification of the head position (PCN).
During the command phase of the recalibrate
operation, the FDC is in the BUSY state, but
during the execution phase it is in a NON-BUSY
state. At this time, another Recalibrate
command may be issued, and in this manner
parallel Recalibrate operations may be done on
up to four drives at once.

Upon power up, the software must issue a
Recalibrate command to properly initialize all
drives and the controller.

Seek

The read/write head within the drive is moved
from track to track under the control of the Seek
command. The FDC compares the PCN, which
is the current head position, with the NCN and
performs the following operation if there is a
difference:

PCN < NCN: Direction signal to drive set to
"1" (step in) and issues step pulses.
PCN > NCN: Direction signal to drive set to
"0" (step out) and issues step pulses.

The rate at which step pulses are issued is
controlled by SRT (Stepping Rate Time) in the
Specify command. After each step pulse is
issued, NCN is compared against PCN, and
when NCN = PCN the SE bit in Status Register
0 is set to "1" and the command is terminated.
During the command phase of the seek or
recalibrate operation, the FDC is in the BUSY
state, but during the execution phase it is in the
NON-BUSY state. At this time, another Seek or
Recalibrate command may be issued, and in
this manner, parallel seek operations may be
done on up to four drives at once.
63
Note that if implied seek is not enabled, the read
and write commands should be preceded by:

1) Seek command - Step to the proper track
2) Sense Interrupt Status command -
Terminate the Seek command
3) Read ID - Verify head is on proper track
4) Issue Read/Write command.

The Seek command does not have a result
phase. Therefore, it is highly recommended that
the Sense Interrupt Status command is issued
after the Seek command to terminate it and to
provide verification of the head position (PCN).
The H bit (Head Address) in ST0 will always
return to a "0". When exiting POWERDOWN
mode, the FDC clears the PCN value and the
status information to zero. Prior to issuing the
POWERDOWN command, it is highly
recommended that the user service all pending
interrupts through the Sense Interrupt Status
command.

Sense Interrupt Status

An interrupt signal on FINT pin is generated by
the FDC for one of the following reasons:

1. Upon entering the Result Phase of:
a. Read Data command
b. Read A Track command
c. Read ID command
d. Read Deleted Data command
e. Write Data command
f.
Format A Track command
g. Write Deleted Data command
h. Verify command

2. End of Seek, Relative Seek, or Recalibrate
command

3. FDC requires a data transfer during the
execution phase in the non-DMA mode

The Sense Interrupt Status command resets the
interrupt signal and, via the IC code and SE bit
of Status Register 0, identifies the cause of the
interrupt.
TABLE 30 - INTERRUPT IDENTIFICATION
The Seek, Relative Seek, and Recalibrate
commands have no result phase. The Sense
Interrupt Status command must be issued
immediately after these commands to terminate
them and to provide verification of the head
position (PCN). The H (Head Address) bit in
ST0 will always return a "0". If a Sense Interrupt
Status is not issued, the drive will continue to be
BUSY and may affect the operation of the next
command.

Sense Drive Status

Sense Drive Status obtains drive status
information. It has not execution phase and
goes directly to the result phase from the
command phase. Status Register 3 contains
the drive status information.

Specify

The Specify command sets the initial values for
each of the three internal times. The HUT
(Head Unload Time) defines the time from the
end of the execution phase of one of the
read/write commands to the head unload state.
The SRT (Step Rate Time) defines the time
interval between adjacent step pulses. Note that
the spacing between the first and second step
pulses may be shorter than the remaining step
pulses. The HLT (Head Load Time) defines the
time between when the Head Load signal goes
high and the read/write operation starts. The
values change with the data rate speed selection
and are documented in Table 27. The values
are the same for MFM and FM.
SE
IC
INTERRUPT DUE TO
0
1

1
11
00

01
Polling
Normal termination of Seek
or Recalibrate command
Abnormal termination of
Seek or Recalibrate
command
64
TABLE 30 - DRIVE CONTROL DELAYS (MS)
HUT
SRT
2M
1M
500K
300K
250K
2M
1M
500K
300K
250K
0
1
..
E
F
64
4
..
56
60
128
8
..
112
120
256
16
..
224
240
426
26.7
..
373
400
512
32
..
448
480
4
3.75
..
0.5
0.25
8
7.5
..
1
0.5
16
15
..
2
1
26.7
25
..
3.33
1.67
32
30
..
4
2
HLT
2M
1M
500K
300K
250K
00
01
02
..
7F
7F
64
0.5
1
..
63
63.5
128
1
2
..
126
127
256
2
4
..
252
254
426
3.3
6.7
..
420
423
512
4
8
.
504
508

The choice of DMA or non-DMA operations is
made by the ND bit. When this bit is "1", the
non-DMA mode is selected, and when ND is "0",
the DMA mode is selected. In DMA mode, data
transfers are signaled by the FDRQ pin. Non-
DMA mode uses the RQM bit and the FINT pin
to signal data transfers.

Configure

The Configure command is issued to select the
special features of the FDC. A Configure
command need not be issued if the default
values of the FDC meet the system
requirements.

Configure Default Values:

EIS - No Implied Seeks
EFIFO - FIFO Disabled
POLL - Polling Enabled
FIFOTHR - FIFO Threshold Set to 1 Byte
PRETRK - Pre-Compensation Set to Track 0
EIS - Enable Implied Seek. When set to "1", the
FDC will perform a Seek operation before
executing a read or write command. Defaults to
no implied seek.

EFIFO - A "1" disables the FIFO (default). This
means data transfers are asked for on a byte-
by-byte basis. Defaults to "1", FIFO disabled.
The threshold defaults to "1".

POLL - Disable polling of the drives. Defaults to
"0", polling enabled. When enabled, a single
interrupt is generated after a reset. No polling is
performed while the drive head is loaded and
the head unload delay has not expired.

FIFOTHR - The FIFO threshold in the execution
phase of read or write commands. This is
programmable from 1 to 16 bytes. Defaults to
one byte. A "00" selects one byte; "0F" selects
16 bytes.

PRETRK - Pre-Compensation Start Track
Number. Programmable from track 0 to 255.
Defaults to track 0. A "00" selects track 0; "FF"
selects track 255.
65
Version

The Version command checks to see if the
controller is an enhanced type or the older type
(765A). A value of 90 H is returned as the result
byte.

Relative Seek

The command is coded the same as for Seek,
except for the MSB of the first byte and the DIR
bit.
DIR
ACTION
0
1
Step Head Out
Step Head In

DIR
Head Step Direction Control

RCN Relative Cylinder Number that
determines how many tracks to step the
head in or out from the current track
number.

The Relative Seek command differs from the
Seek command in that it steps the head the
absolute number of tracks specified in the
command instead of making a comparison
against an internal register. The Seek
command is good for drives that support a
maximum of 256 tracks. Relative Seeks cannot
be overlapped with other Relative Seeks. Only
one Relative Seek can be active at a time.
Relative Seeks may be overlapped with Seeks
and Recalibrates. Bit 4 of Status Register 0
(EC) will be set if Relative Seek attempts to step
outward beyond Track 0.

As an example, assume that a floppy drive has
300 useable tracks. The host needs to read
track 300 and the head is on any track (0-255).
If a Seek command is issued, the head will stop
at track 255. If a Relative Seek command is
issued, the FDC will move the head the
specified number of tracks, regardless of the
internal cylinder position register (but will
increment the register). If the head was on track
40 (d), the maximum track that the FDC could
position the head on using Relative Seek will be
295 (D), the initial track + 255 (D). The
maximum count that the head can be moved
with a single Relative Seek command is 255
(D).

The internal register, PCN, will overflow as the
cylinder number crosses track 255 and will
contain 39 (D). The resulting PCN value is thus
(RCN + PCN) mod 256. Functionally, the FDC
starts counting from 0 again as the track
number goes above 255 (D). It is the user's
responsibility to compensate FDC functions
(precompensation track number) when
accessing tracks greater than 255. The FDC
does not keep track that it is working in an
"extended track area" (greater than 255). Any
command issued will use the current PCN value
except for the Recalibrate command, which only
looks for the TRACK0 signal. Recalibrate will
return an error if the head is farther than 79 due
to its limitation of issuing a maximum of 80 step
pulses. The user simply needs to issue a second
Recalibrate command. The Seek command and
implied seeks will function correctly within the
44 (D) track (299-255) area of the "extended
track area". It is the user's responsibility not to
issue a new track position that will exceed the
maximum track that is present in the extended
area.

To return to the standard floppy range (0-255) of
tracks, a Relative Seek should be issued to
cross the track 255 boundary.

A Relative Seek can be used instead of the
normal Seek, but the host is required to
calculate the difference between the current
head location and the new (target) head
location. This may require the host to issue a
Read ID command to ensure that the head is
physically on the track that software assumes it
to be. Different FDC commands will return
different cylinder results which may be difficult
to keep track of with software without the Read
ID command.
66
Perpendicular Mode

The Perpendicular Mode command should be
issued prior to executing Read/Write/Format
commands that access a disk drive with
perpendicular recording capability. With this
command, the length of the Gap2 field and VCO
enable timing can be altered to accommodate
the unique requirements of these drives. Table
28 describes the effects of the WGATE and
GAP bits for the Perpendicular Mode command.
Upon a reset, the FDC will default to the
conventional mode (WGATE = 0, GAP = 0).

Selection of the 500 Kbps and 1 Mbps
perpendicular modes is independent of the
actual data rate selected in the Data Rate Select
Register. The user must ensure that these two
data rates remain consistent.

The Gap2 and VCO timing requirements for
perpendicular recording type drives are dictated
by the design of the read/write head. In the
design of this head, a pre-erase head precedes
the normal read/write head by a distance of 200
micrometers. This works out to about 38 bytes
at a 1 Mbps recording density. Whenever the
write head is enabled by the Write Gate signal,
the pre-erase head is also activated at the same
time. Thus, when the write head is initially
turned on, flux transitions recorded on the media
for the first 38 bytes will not be preconditioned
with the pre-erase head since it has not yet been
activated. To accommodate this head activation
and deactivation time, the Gap2 field is
expanded to a length of 41 bytes. The format
field shown on Page 58 illustrates the change in
the Gap2 field size for the perpendicular format.

On the read back by the FDC, the controller
must begin synchronization at the beginning of
the sync field. For the conventional mode, the
internal PLL VCO is enabled (VCOEN)
approximately 24 bytes from the start of the
Gap2 field. But, when the controller operates in
the 1 Mbps perpendicular mode (WGATE = 1,
GAP = 1), VCOEN goes active after 43 bytes to
accommodate the increased Gap2 field size.
For both cases, and approximate two-byte
cushion is maintained from the beginning of the
sync field for the purposes of avoiding write
splices in the presence of motor speed variation.

For the Write Data case, the FDC activates
Write Gate at the beginning of the sync field
under the conventional mode. The controller
then writes a new sync field, data address mark,
data field, and CRC as shown on page 57. With
the pre-erase head of the perpendicular drive,
the write head must be activated in the Gap2
field to insure a proper write of the new sync
field. For the 1 Mbps perpendicular mode
(WGATE = 1, GAP = 1), 38 bytes will be written
in the Gap2 space. Since the bit density is
proportional to the data rate, 19 bytes will be
written in the Gap2 field for the 500 Kbps
perpendicular mode (WGATE = 1, GAP =0).

It should be noted that none of the alterations in
Gap2 size, VCO timing, or Write Gate timing
affect normal program flow. The information
provided here is just for background purposes
and is not needed for normal operation. Once
the Perpendicular Mode command is invoked,
FDC software behavior from the user standpoint
is unchanged.

The perpendicular mode command is enhanced
to allow specific drives to be designated
Perpendicular recording drives. This
enhancement allows data transfers between
Conventional and Perpendicular drives without
having to issue Perpendicular mode commands
between the accesses of the different drive
types, nor having to change write pre-
compensation values.

When both GAP and WGATE bits of the
PERPENDICULAR MODE COMMAND are both
programmed to "0" (Conventional mode), then
D0, D1, D2, D3, and D4 can be programmed
independently to "1" for that drive to be set
automatically to Perpendicular mode. In this
mode the following set of conditions also apply:
1. The GAP2 written to a perpendicular drive
during a write operation will depend upon the
programmed data rate.
67
2. The write pre-compensation given to a
perpendicular mode drive will be 0ns.
3. For D0-D3 programmed to "0" for
conventional mode drives any data written
will be at the currently programmed write
pre-compensation.

Note: Bits D0-D3 can only be overwritten when
OW is programmed as a "1".If either GAP or
WGATE is a "1" then D0-D3 are ignored.
Software and hardware resets have the
following effect on the PERPENDICULAR
MODE COMMAND:
1. "Software" resets (via the DOR or DSR
registers) will only clear GAP and WGATE
bits to "0". D0-D3 are unaffected and retain
their previous value.
2. "Hardware" resets will clear all bits
(GAP, WGATE and D0-D3) to "0", i.e all
conventional mode.
TABLE 31 - EFFECTS OF WGATE AND GAP BITS


WGATE


GAP


MODE
LENGTH OF
GAP2 FORMAT
FIELD
PORTION OF
GAP 2 WRITTEN
BY WRITE DATA
OPERATION
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Conventional
Perpendicular
(500 Kbps)
Reserved
(Conventional)
Perpendicular
(1 Mbps)
22 Bytes
22 Bytes
22 Bytes
41 Bytes
0 Bytes
19 Bytes
0 Bytes
38 Bytes
68
LOCK

In order to protect systems with long DMA
latencies against older application software that
can disable the FIFO the LOCK Command has
been added. This command should only be
used by the FDC routines, and application
software should refrain from using it. If an
application calls for the FIFO to be disabled
then the CONFIGURE command should be
used.

The LOCK command defines whether the
EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK parameters of
the CONFIGURE command can be RESET by
the DOR and DSR registers. When the LOCK
bit is set to logic "1" all subsequent "software
RESETS by the DOR and DSR registers will not
change the previously set parameters to their
default values. All "hardware" RESET from the
RESET pin will set the LOCK bit to logic "0" and
return the EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK to
their default values. A status byte is returned
immediately after issuing a LOCK command.
This byte reflects the value of the LOCK bit set
by the command byte.


ENHANCED DUMPREG

The DUMPREG command is designed to
support system run-time diagnostics and
application software development and debug.
To accommodate the LOCK command and the
enhanced PERPENDICULAR MODE command
the eighth byte of the DUMPREG command has
been modified to contain the additional data
from these two commands.


COMPATIBILITY

This chip was designed with software
compatibility in mind. It is a fully backwards-
compatible solution with the older generation
765A/B disk controllers. The FDC also
implements on-board registers for compatibility
with the PS/2, as well as PC/AT and PC/XT,
floppy disk controller subsystems. After a
hardware reset of the FDC, all registers,
functions and enhancements default to a PC/AT,
PS/2 or PS/2 Model 30 compatible operating
mode, depending on how the IDENT and MFM
bits are configured by the system BIOS.

FORCE WRITE PROTECT

The Force Write Protect function forces the FDD
nWRTPRT input active if the FORCE WRTPRT
bit is active. The Force Write Protect function
applies to the nWRTPRT pin in the FDD
Interface as well as the nWRTPRT pin in the
Parallel Port FDC. Refer to Configuration
Register L8CR_C5 for more information.
69
SERIAL PORT (UART)

The chip incorporates two full function UARTs.
They are compatible with the NS16450, the
16450 ACE registers and the NS16C550A. The
UARTS perform serial-to-parallel conversion on
received characters and parallel-to-serial
conversion on transmit characters. The data
rates are independently programmable from
460.8K baud down to 50 baud. The character
options are programmable for 1 start; 1, 1.5 or 2
stop bits; even, odd, sticky or no parity; and
prioritized interrupts. The UARTs each contain a
programmable baud rate generator that is
capable of dividing the input clock or crystal by
a number from 1 to 65535. The UARTs are also
capable of supporting the MIDI data rate. Refer
to the Configuration Registers for information on
disabling, power down and changing the base
address of the UARTs. The interrupt from a
UART is enabled by programming OUT2 of that
UART to a logic "1". OUT2 being a logic "0"
disables that UART's interrupt. The second
UART also supports IrDA 1.0, HP-SIR and ASK-
IR infrared modes of operation.

Note: The UARTs may be configured to share
an interrupt. Refer to the Configuration section
for more information.


REGISTER DESCRIPTION

Addressing of the accessible registers of the
Serial Port is shown below. The configuration
registers (see Configuration section) define the
base addresses of the serial ports. The Serial
Port registers are located at sequentially
increasing addresses above these base
addresses. The chip contains two serial ports,
each of which contain a register set as
described below.
TABLE 32 - ADDRESSING THE SERIAL PORT
DLAB*
A2
A1
A0
REGISTER NAME
0
0
0
0
Receive Buffer (read)
0
0
0
0
Transmit Buffer (write)
0
0
0
1
Interrupt Enable (read/write)
X
0
1
0
Interrupt Identification (read)
X
0
1
0
FIFO Control (write)
X
0
1
1
Line Control (read/write)
X
1
0
0
Modem Control (read/write)
X
1
0
1
Line Status (read/write)
X
1
1
0
Modem Status (read/write)
X
1
1
1
Scratchpad (read/write)
1
0
0
0
Divisor LSB (read/write)
1
0
0
1
Divisor MSB (read/write
*Note: DLAB is Bit 7 of the Line Control Register

The following section describes the operation of the registers.
70
RECEIVE BUFFER REGISTER (RB)
Address Offset = 0H, DLAB = 0, READ ONLY
This register holds the received incoming data
byte. Bit 0 is the least significant bit, which is
transmitted and received first. Received data is
double buffered; this uses an additional shift
register to receive the serial data stream and
convert it to a parallel 8 bit word which is
transferred to the Receive Buffer register. The
shift register is not accessible.

TRANSMIT BUFFER REGISTER (TB)
Address Offset = 0H, DLAB = 0, WRITE ONLY

This register contains the data byte to be
transmitted. The transmit buffer is double
buffered, utilizing an additional shift register (not
accessible) to convert the 8 bit data word to a
serial format. This shift register is loaded from
the Transmit Buffer when the transmission of
the previous byte is complete.

INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER (IER)
Address Offset = 1H, DLAB = 0, READ/WRITE

The lower four bits of this register control the
enables of the five interrupt sources of the Serial
Port interrupt. It is possible to totally disable the
interrupt system by resetting bits 0 through 3 of
this register. Similarly, setting the appropriate
bits of this register to a high, selected interrupts
can be enabled. Disabling the interrupt system
inhibits the Interrupt Identification Register and
disables any Serial Port interrupt out of the chip.
All other system functions operate in their
normal manner, including the Line Status and
MODEM Status Registers. The contents of the
Interrupt Enable Register are described below.

Bit 0
This bit enables the Received Data Available
Interrupt (and timeout interrupts in the FIFO
mode) when set to logic "1".
Bit 1
This bit enables the Transmitter Holding
Register Empty Interrupt when set to logic "1".
Bit 2
This bit enables the Received Line Status
Interrupt when set to logic "1". The error
sources causing the interrupt are Overrun,
Parity, Framing and Break. The Line Status
Register must be read to determine the source.
Bit 3
This bit enables the MODEM Status Interrupt
when set to logic "1". This is caused when one
of the Modem Status Register bits changes
state.
Bits 4 through 7
These bits are always logic "0".

FIFO CONTROL REGISTER (FCR)
Address Offset = 2H, DLAB = X, WRITE

This is a write only register at the same location
as the IIR. This register is used to enable and
clear the FIFOs, set the RCVR FIFO trigger
level. Note: DMA is not supported. The UART1
and UART2 FCR's are shadowed in the UART1
FIFO Control Shadow Register (LD8:CRC3[7:0])
and UART2 FIFO Control Shadow Register
(LD8:CRC4[7:0]).

Bit 0
Setting this bit to a logic "1" enables both the
XMIT and RCVR FIFOs. Clearing this bit to a
logic "0" disables both the XMIT and RCVR
FIFOs and clears all bytes from both FIFOs.
When changing from FIFO Mode to non-FIFO
(16450) mode, data is automatically cleared
from the FIFOs. This bit must be a 1 when
other bits in this register are written to or they
will not be properly programmed.

Bit 1
Setting this bit to a logic "1" clears all bytes in
the RCVR FIFO and resets its counter logic to 0.
The shift register is not cleared. This bit is self-
clearing.
71
Bit 2
Setting this bit to a logic "1" clears all bytes in
the XMIT FIFO and resets its counter logic to 0.
The shift register is not cleared. This bit is self-
clearing.
Bit 3
Writing to this bit has no effect on the operation
of the UART. The RXRDY and TXRDY pins are
not available on this chip.
Bit 4,5
Reserved
Bit 6,7
These bits are used to set the trigger level for
the RCVR FIFO interrupt.
Bit 7
Bit 6
RCVR FIFO
Trigger Level (BYTES)
0
0
1
0
1
4
1
0
8
1
1
14


INTERRUPT IDENTIFICATION REGISTER
(IIR)
Address Offset = 2H, DLAB = X, READ

By accessing this register, the host CPU can
determine the highest priority interrupt and its
source. Four levels of priority interrupt exist.
They are in descending order of priority:

1.
Receiver Line Status (highest priority)
2.
Received Data Ready
3.
Transmitter Holding Register Empty
4.
MODEM Status (lowest priority)
Information indicating that a prioritized interrupt
is pending and the source of that interrupt is
stored in the Interrupt Identification Register
(refer to Interrupt Control Table). When the CPU
accesses the IIR, the Serial Port freezes all
interrupts and indicates the highest priority
pending interrupt to the CPU. During this CPU
access, even if the Serial Port records new
interrupts, the current indication does not
change until access is completed. The contents
of the IIR are described below.

Bit 0

This bit can be used in either a hardwired
prioritized or polled environment to indicate
whether an interrupt is pending. When bit 0 is a
logic "0", an interrupt is pending and the
contents of the IIR may be used as a pointer to
the appropriate internal service routine. When
bit 0 is a logic "1", no interrupt is pending.

Bits 1 and 2
These two bits of the IIR are used to identify the
highest priority interrupt pending as indicated by
the Interrupt Control Table.

Bit 3
In non-FIFO mode, this bit is a logic "0". In
FIFO mode this bit is set along with bit 2 when a
timeout interrupt is pending.

Bits 4 and 5
These bits of the IIR are always logic "0".

Bits 6 and 7
These two bits are set when the FIFO
CONTROL Register bit 0 equals 1.



72
TABLE 33 - INTERRUPT CONTROL
FIFO
MODE
ONLY
INTERRUPT
IDENTIFICATION
REGISTER

INTERRUPT SET AND RESET FUNCTIONS
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
PRIORITY
LEVEL
INTERRUPT
TYPE
INTERRUPT
SOURCE
INTERRUPT
RESET CONTROL
0
0
0
1
-
None
None
-
0
1
1
0
Highest
Receiver Line
Status
Overrun Error,
Parity Error,
Framing Error or
Break Interrupt
Reading the Line
Status Register
0
1
0
0
Second
Received
Data
Available
Receiver Data
Available
Read Receiver
Buffer or the FIFO
drops below the
trigger level.
1
1
0
0
Second
Character
Timeout
Indication
No Characters
Have Been
Removed From
or Input to the
RCVR FIFO
during the last 4
Char times and
there is at least 1
char in it during
this time
Reading the
Receiver Buffer
Register
0
0
1
0
Third
Transmitter
Holding
Register
Empty
Transmitter
Holding Register
Empty
Reading the IIR
Register (if Source
of Interrupt) or
Writing the
Transmitter
Holding Register
0
0
0
0
Fourth
MODEM
Status
Clear to Send or
Data Set Ready
or Ring Indicator
or Data Carrier
Detect
Reading the
MODEM Status
Register
73
BIT 2
WORD LENGTH
NUMBER OF
STOP BITS
0
--
1
1
5 bits
1.5
1
6 bits
2
1
7 bits
2
1
8 bits
2

LINE CONTROL REGISTER (LCR)
Address Offset = 3H, DLAB = 0, READ/WRITE
This register contains the format information of
the serial line. The bit definitions are:

Bits 0 and 1
These two bits specify the number of bits in
each transmitted or received serial character.
The encoding of bits 0 and 1 is as follows:

The Start, Stop and Parity bits are not included
in the word length.
BIT 1
BIT 0
WORD LENGTH
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
5 Bits
6 Bits
7 Bits
8 Bits

Bit 2
This bit specifies the number of stop bits in each
transmitted or received serial character. The
following table summarizes the information.
Note: The receiver will ignore all stop bits
beyond the first, regardless of the number used
in transmitting.
Bit 3
Parity Enable bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1", a
parity bit is generated (transmit data) or
checked (receive data) between the last data
word bit and the first stop bit of the serial data.
(The parity bit is used to generate an even or
odd number of 1s when the data word bits and
the parity bit are summed).
Bit 4
Even Parity Select bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1"
and bit 4 is a logic "0", an odd number of logic
"1"'s is transmitted or checked in the data word
bits and the parity bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1"
and bit 4 is a logic "1" an even number of bits is
transmitted and checked.
Bit 5
Stick Parity bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1" and bit
5 is a logic "1", the parity bit is transmitted and
then detected by the receiver in the opposite
state indicated by bit 4.
Bit 6
Set Break Control bit. When bit 6 is a logic "1",
the transmit data output (TXD) is forced to the
Spacing or logic "0" state and remains there
(until reset by a low level bit 6) regardless of
other transmitter activity. This feature enables
the Serial Port to alert a terminal in a
communications system.
Bit 7
Divisor Latch Access bit (DLAB). It must be set
high (logic "1") to access the Divisor Latches of
the Baud Rate Generator during read or write
operations. It must be set low (logic "0") to
access the Receiver Buffer Register, the
Transmitter Holding Register, or the Interrupt
Enable Register.
74
MODEM CONTROL REGISTER (MCR)
Address Offset = 4H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE
This 8 bit register controls the interface with the
MODEM or data set (or device emulating a
MODEM). The contents of the MODEM control
register are described below.
Bit 0
This bit controls the Data Terminal Ready
(nDTR) output. When bit 0 is set to a logic "1",
the nDTR output is forced to a logic "0". When
bit 0 is a logic "0", the nDTR output is forced to
a logic "1".
Bit 1
This bit controls the Request To Send (nRTS)
output. Bit 1 affects the nRTS output in a
manner identical to that described above for bit
0.
Bit 2
This bit controls the Output 1 (OUT1) bit. This
bit does not have an output pin and can only be
read or written by the CPU.
Bit 3
Output 2 (OUT2). This bit is used to enable an
UART interrupt. When OUT2 is a logic "0", the
serial port interrupt output is forced to a high
impedance state - disabled. When OUT2 is a
logic "1", the serial port interrupt outputs are
enabled.
Bit 4
This bit provides the loopback feature for
diagnostic testing of the Serial Port. When bit 4
is set to logic "1", the following occur:

1. The TXD is set to the Marking State(logic
"1").
2. The receiver Serial Input (RXD) is
disconnected.
3. The output of the Transmitter Shift Register
is "looped back" into the Receiver Shift
Register input.
4. All MODEM Control inputs (nCTS, nDSR,
nRI and nDCD) are disconnected.
5. The four MODEM Control outputs (nDTR,
nRTS, OUT1 and OUT2) are internally
connected to the four MODEM Control inputs
(nDSR, nCTS, RI, DCD).
6. The Modem Control output pins are forced
inactive high.
7. Data that is transmitted is immediately
received.

This feature allows the processor to verify the
transmit and receive data paths of the Serial
Port. In the diagnostic mode, the receiver and
the transmitter interrupts are fully operational.
The MODEM Control Interrupts are also
operational but the interrupts' sources are now
the lower four bits of the MODEM Control
Register instead of the MODEM Control inputs.
The interrupts are still controlled by the Interrupt
Enable Register.

Bits 5 through 7
These bits are permanently set to logic zero.

LINE STATUS REGISTER (LSR)
Address Offset = 5H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE

Bit 0
Data Ready (DR). It is set to a logic "1"
whenever a complete incoming character has
been received and transferred into the Receiver
Buffer Register or the FIFO. Bit 0 is reset to a
logic "0" by reading all of the data in the Receive
Buffer Register or the FIFO.
Bit 1
Overrun Error (OE). Bit 1 indicates that data in
the Receiver Buffer Register was not read before
the next character was transferred into the
register, thereby destroying the previous
character. In FIFO mode, an overrun error will
occur only when the FIFO is full and the next
character has been completely received in the
shift register, the character in the shift register is
overwritten but not transferred to the FIFO. The
OE indicator is set to a logic "1" immediately
upon detection of an overrun condition, and
reset whenever the Line Status Register is read.
Bit 2
Parity Error (PE). Bit 2 indicates that the
received data character does not have the
correct even or odd parity, as selected by the
even parity select bit. The PE is set to a logic
"1" upon detection of a parity error and is reset
to a logic "0" whenever the Line Status Register
is read. In the FIFO mode this error is
75
associated with the particular character in the
FIFO it applies to. This error is indicated when
the associated character is at the top of the
FIFO.
Bit 3
Framing Error (FE). Bit 3 indicates that the
received character did not have a valid stop bit.
Bit 3 is set to a logic "1" whenever the stop bit
following the last data bit or parity bit is detected
as a zero bit (Spacing level). The FE is reset to
a logic "0" whenever the Line Status Register is
read. In the FIFO mode this error is associated
with the particular character in the FIFO it
applies to. This error is indicated when the
associated character is at the top of the FIFO.
The Serial Port will try to resynchronize after a
framing error. To do this, it assumes that the
framing error was due to the next start bit, so it
samples this 'start' bit twice and then takes in
the 'data'.
Bit 4
Break Interrupt (BI). Bit 4 is set to a logic "1"
whenever the received data input is held in the
Spacing state (logic "0") for longer than a full
word transmission time (that is, the total time of
the start bit + data bits + parity bits + stop bits).
The BI is reset after the CPU reads the contents
of the Line Status Register. In the FIFO mode
this error is associated with the particular
character in the FIFO it applies to. This error is
indicated when the associated character is at
the top of the FIFO. When break occurs only
one zero character is loaded into the FIFO.
Restarting after a break is received, requires the
serial data (RXD) to be logic "1" for at least 1/2
bit time.

Note: Bits 1 through 4 are the error conditions
that produce a Receiver Line Status Interrupt
whenever any of the corresponding conditions
are detected and the interrupt is enabled.
Bit 5
Transmitter Holding Register Empty (THRE).
Bit 5 indicates that the Serial Port is ready to
accept a new character for transmission. In
addition, this bit causes the Serial Port to issue
an interrupt when the Transmitter Holding
Register interrupt enable is set high. The THRE
bit is set to a logic "1" when a character is
transferred from the Transmitter Holding
Register into the Transmitter Shift Register. The
bit is reset to logic "0" whenever the CPU loads
the Transmitter Holding Register. In the FIFO
mode this bit is set when the XMIT FIFO is
empty, it is cleared when at least 1 byte is
written to the XMIT FIFO. Bit 5 is a read only
bit.
Bit 6
Transmitter Empty (TEMT). Bit 6 is set to a
logic "1" whenever the Transmitter Holding
Register (THR) and Transmitter Shift Register
(TSR) are both empty. It is reset to logic "0"
whenever either the THR or TSR contains a data
character. Bit 6 is a read only bit. In the FIFO
mode this bit is set whenever the THR and TSR
are both empty,
Bit 7
This bit is permanently set to logic "0" in the 450
mode. In the FIFO mode, this bit is set to a
logic "1" when there is at least one parity error,
framing error or break indication in the FIFO.
This bit is cleared when the LSR is read if there
are no subsequent errors in the FIFO.

MODEM STATUS REGISTER (MSR)
Address Offset = 6H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE

This 8 bit register provides the current state of
the control lines from the MODEM (or peripheral
device). In addition to this current state
information, four bits of the MODEM Status
Register (MSR) provide change information.
These bits are set to logic "1" whenever a
control input from the MODEM changes state.
They are reset to logic "0" whenever the
MODEM Status Register is read.
76
Bit 0
Delta Clear To Send (DCTS). Bit 0 indicates
that the nCTS input to the chip has changed
state since the last time the MSR was read.
Bit 1
Delta Data Set Ready (DDSR). Bit 1 indicates
that the nDSR input has changed state since the
last time the MSR was read.
Bit 2
Trailing Edge of Ring Indicator (TERI). Bit 2
indicates that the nRI input has changed from
logic "0" to logic "1".
Bit 3
Delta Data Carrier Detect (DDCD). Bit 3
indicates that the nDCD input to the chip has
changed state.

Note: Whenever bit 0, 1, 2, or 3 is set to a logic
"1", a MODEM Status Interrupt is generated.
Bit 4
This bit is the complement of the Clear To Send
(nCTS) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic
"1", this bit is equivalent to nRTS in the MCR.
Bit 5
This bit is the complement of the Data Set
Ready (nDSR) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set
to logic "1", this bit is equivalent to DTR in the
MCR.
Bit 6
This bit is the complement of the Ring Indicator
(nRI) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic
"1", this bit is equivalent to OUT1 in the MCR.
Bit 7
This bit is the complement of the Data Carrier
Detect (nDCD) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set
to logic "1", this bit is equivalent to OUT2 in the
MCR.

SCRATCHPAD REGISTER (SCR)
Address Offset =7H, DLAB =X, READ/WRITE
This 8 bit read/write register has no effect on the
operation of the Serial Port. It is intended as a
scratchpad register to be used by the
programmer to hold data temporarily.

PROGRAMMABLE BAUD RATE GENERATOR
(AND DIVISOR LATCHES DLH, DLL)
The Serial Port contains a programmable Baud
Rate Generator that is capable of taking any
clock input (DC to 3 MHz) and dividing it by any
divisor from 1 to 65535. This output frequency
of the Baud Rate Generator is 16x the Baud
rate. Two 8 bit latches store the divisor in 16 bit
binary format. These Divisor Latches must be
loaded during initialization in order to insure
desired operation of the Baud Rate Generator.
Upon loading either of the Divisor Latches, a 16
bit Baud counter is immediately loaded. This
prevents long counts on initial load. If a 0 is
loaded into the BRG registers the output divides
the clock by the number 3. If a 1 is loaded the
output is the inverse of the input oscillator. If a
two is loaded the output is a divide by 2 signal
with a 50% duty cycle. If a 3 or greater is
loaded the output is low for 2 bits and high for
the remainder of the count. The input clock to
the BRG is a 1.8462 MHz clock.

Table 31 shows the baud rates possible with a
1.8462 MHz crystal.

77
Table 34 - Baud Rates Using 1.8462 MHz Clock for <= 38.4K; Using 1.8432MHz Clock
for 115.2k ; Using 3.6864MHz Clock for 230.4k; Using 7.3728 MHz Clock for 460.8k
DESIRED
BAUD RATE
DIVISOR USED TO
GENERATE 16X CLOCK
PERCENT ERROR DIFFERENCE
BETWEEN DESIRED AND ACTUAL
1
HIGH
SPEED BIT
2
50
2304
0.001
X
75
1536
-
X
110
1047
-
X
134.5
857
0.004
X
150
768
-
X
300
384
-
X
600
192
-
X
1200
96
-
X
1800
64
-
X
2000
58
0.005
X
2400
48
-
X
3600
32
-
X
4800
24
-
X
7200
16
-
X
9600
12
-
X
19200
6
-
X
38400
3
0.030
X
57600
2
0.16
X
115200
1
0.16
X
230400
32770
0.16
1
460800
32769
0.16
1
Note
1
: The percentage error for all baud rates, except where indicated otherwise, is 0.2%.
Note
2
: The High Speed bit is located in the Device Configuration Space.

Effect Of The Reset on Register File

The Reset Function Table (Table 35) details the effect of the Reset input on each of the registers of
the Serial Port.
78
FIFO INTERRUPT MODE OPERATION

When the RCVR FIFO and receiver interrupts
are enabled (FCR bit 0 = "1", IER bit 0 = "1"),
RCVR interrupts occur as follows:

A. The receive data available interrupt will be
issued when the FIFO has reached its
programmed trigger level; it is cleared as
soon as the FIFO drops below its
programmed trigger level.

B. The IIR receive data available indication also
occurs when the FIFO trigger level is
reached. It is cleared when the FIFO drops
below the trigger level.

C. The receiver line status interrupt (IIR=06H),
has higher priority than the received data
available (IIR=04H) interrupt.

D. The data ready bit (LSR bit 0) is set as soon
as a character is transferred from the shift
register to the RCVR FIFO. It is reset when
the FIFO is empty.

When RCVR FIFO and receiver interrupts are
enabled, RCVR FIFO timeout interrupts occur
as follows:

A. A FIFO timeout interrupt occurs if all the
following conditions exist:
- At least one character is in the FIFO.
- The most recent serial character received
was longer than 4 continuous character
times ago. (If 2 stop bits are programmed,
the second one is included in this time
delay).
- The most recent CPU read of the FIFO was
longer than 4 continuous character times
ago.

This will cause a maximum character received
to interrupt issued delay of 160 msec at 300
BAUD with a 12 bit character.
B. Character times are calculated by using the
RCLK input for a clock signal (this makes
the delay proportional to the baudrate).

C. When a timeout interrupt has occurred it is
cleared and the timer reset when the CPU
reads one character from the RCVR FIFO.

D. When a timeout interrupt has not occurred
the timeout timer is reset after a new
character is received or after the CPU reads
the RCVR FIFO.

When the XMIT FIFO and transmitter interrupts
are enabled (FCR bit 0 = "1", IER bit 1 = "1"),
XMIT interrupts occur as follows:

A. The transmitter holding register interrupt
(02H) occurs when the XMIT FIFO is empty;
it is cleared as soon as the transmitter
holding register is written to (1 of 16
characters may be written to the XMIT FIFO
while servicing this interrupt) or the IIR is
read.

B. The transmitter FIFO empty indications will
be delayed 1 character time minus the last
stop bit time whenever the following occurs:
THRE=1 and there have not been at least
two bytes at the same time in the transmitter
FIFO since the last THRE=1. The transmitter
interrupt after changing FCR0 will be
immediate, if it is enabled.

Character timeout and RCVR FIFO trigger level
interrupts have the same priority as the current
received data available interrupt; XMIT FIFO
empty has the same priority as the current
transmitter holding register empty interrupt.
79
FIFO POLLED MODE OPERATION

With FCR bit 0 = "1" resetting IER bits 0, 1, 2 or
3 or all to zero puts the UART in the FIFO
Polled Mode of operation. Since the RCVR and
XMITTER are controlled separately, either one
or both can be in the polled mode of operation.
In this mode, the user's program will check
RCVR and XMITTER status via the LSR. LSR
definitions for the FIFO Polled Mode are as
follows:
- Bit 0=1 as long as there is one byte in the
RCVR FIFO.
- Bits 1 to 4 specify which error(s) have
occurred. Character error status is handled
the same way as when in the interrupt
mode, the IIR is not affected since EIR bit
2=0.
- Bit 5 indicates when the XMIT FIFO is
empty.
- Bit 6 indicates that both the XMIT FIFO and
shift register are empty.
- Bit 7 indicates whether there are any errors
in the RCVR FIFO.

There is no trigger level reached or timeout
condition indicated in the FIFO Polled Mode,
however, the RCVR and XMIT FIFOs are still
fully capable of holding characters.
80
TABLE 35 - RESET FUNCTION
REGISTER/SIGNAL
RESET CONTROL
RESET STATE
Interrupt Enable Register
RESET
All bits low
Interrupt Identification Reg.
RESET
Bit 0 is high; Bits 1 - 7 low
FIFO Control
RESET
All bits low
Line Control Reg.
RESET
All bits low
MODEM Control Reg.
RESET
All bits low
Line Status Reg.
RESET
All bits low except 5, 6 high
MODEM Status Reg.
RESET
Bits 0 - 3 low; Bits 4 - 7 input
TXD1, TXD2
RESET
High
INTRPT (RCVR errs)
RESET/Read LSR
Low
INTRPT (RCVR Data Ready)
RESET/Read RBR
Low
INTRPT (THRE)
RESET/ReadIIR/Write THR
Low
OUT2B
RESET
High
RTSB
RESET
High
DTRB
RESET
High
OUT1B
RESET
High
RCVR FIFO
RESET/
FCR1*FCR0/_FCR0
All Bits Low
XMIT FIFO
RESET/
FCR1*FCR0/_FCR0
All Bits Low
81
TABLE 36 - REGISTER SUMMARY FOR AN INDIVIDUAL UART CHANNEL
REGISTER
ADDRESS*
REGISTER NAME
REGISTER
SYMBOL
BIT 0
BIT 1
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 0
Receive Buffer Register (Read Only)
RBR
Data Bit 0
(Note 1)
Data Bit 1
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 0
Transmitter Holding Register (Write
Only)
THR
Data Bit 0
Data Bit 1
ADDR = 1
DLAB = 0
Interrupt Enable Register
IER
Enable
Received
Data
Available
Interrupt
(ERDAI)
Enable
Transmitter
Holding
Register
Empty
Interrupt
(ETHREI)
ADDR = 2
Interrupt Ident. Register (Read Only)
IIR
"0" if
Interrupt
Pending
Interrupt ID
Bit
ADDR = 2
FIFO Control Register (Write Only)
FCR
(Note 7)
FIFO
Enable
RCVR FIFO
Reset
ADDR = 3
Line Control Register
LCR
Word
Length
Select Bit 0
(WLS0)
Word
Length
Select Bit 1
(WLS1)
ADDR = 4
MODEM Control Register
MCR
Data
Terminal
Ready
(DTR)
Request to
Send (RTS)
ADDR = 5
Line Status Register
LSR
Data Ready
(DR)
Overrun
Error (OE)
ADDR = 6
MODEM Status Register
MSR
Delta Clear
to Send
(DCTS)
Delta Data
Set Ready
(DDSR)
ADDR = 7
Scratch Register (Note 4)
SCR
Bit 0
Bit 1
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 1
Divisor Latch (LS)
DDL
Bit 0
Bit 1
ADDR = 1
DLAB = 1
Divisor Latch (MS)
DLM
Bit 8
Bit 9
*DLAB is Bit 7 of the Line Control Register (ADDR = 3).
Note 1: Bit 0 is the least significant bit. It is the first bit serially transmitted or received.
Note 2: When operating in the XT mode, this bit will be set any time that the transmitter shift
register is empty.
82
TABLE 37 - REGISTER SUMMARY FOR AN INDIVIDUAL UART CHANNEL (CONTINUED)
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
Data Bit 2
Data Bit 3
Data Bit 4
Data Bit 5
Data Bit 6
Data Bit 7
Data Bit 2
Data Bit 3
Data Bit 4
Data Bit 5
Data Bit 6
Data Bit 7
Enable
Receiver Line
Status
Interrupt
(ELSI)
Enable
MODEM
Status
Interrupt
(EMSI)
0
0
0
0



Interrupt ID
Bit
Interrupt ID
Bit (Note 5)
0
0
FIFOs
Enabled
(Note 5)
FIFOs
Enabled
(Note 5)
XMIT FIFO
Reset
DMA Mode
Select (Note
6)
Reserved
Reserved
RCVR Trigger
LSB
RCVR Trigger
MSB
Number of
Stop Bits
(STB)
Parity Enable
(PEN)
Even Parity
Select (EPS)
Stick Parity
Set Break
Divisor Latch
Access Bit
(DLAB)
OUT1
(Note 3)
OUT2
(Note 3)
Loop
0
0
0
Parity Error
(PE)
Framing Error
(FE)
Break
Interrupt (BI)
Transmitter
Holding
Register
(THRE)
Transmitter
Empty
(TEMT)
(Note 2)
Error in
RCVR FIFO
(Note 5)
Trailing Edge
Ring Indicator
(TERI)
Delta Data
Carrier Detect
(DDCD)
Clear to Send
(CTS)
Data Set
Ready (DSR)
Ring Indicator
(RI)
Data Carrier
Detect (DCD)
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Bit 10
Bit 11
Bit 12
Bit 13
Bit 14
Bit 15
Note 3: This bit no longer has a pin associated with it.
Note 4: When operating in the XT mode, this register is not available.
Note 5: These bits are always zero in the non-FIFO mode.
Note 6: Writing a one to this bit has no effect. DMA modes are not supported in this chip.
Note 7: The UART1 and UART2 FCR's are shadowed in the UART1 FIFO Control Shadow
Register (LD8:CRC3[7:0]) and UART2 FIFO Control Shadow Register (LD8:CRC4[7:0]).

83
NOTES ON SERIAL PORT OPERATION

FIFO MODE OPERATION:

GENERAL

The RCVR FIFO will hold up to 16 bytes
regardless of which trigger level is selected.

TX AND RX FIFO OPERATION

The Tx portion of the UART transmits data
through TXD as soon as the CPU loads a byte
into the Tx FIFO. The UART will prevent
loads to the Tx FIFO if it currently holds 16
characters.
Loading to the Tx FIFO will again
be enabled as soon as the next character is
transferred to the Tx shift register. These
capabilities account for the largely autonomous
operation of the Tx.

The UART starts the above operations typically
with a Tx interrupt. The chip issues a Tx
interrupt whenever the Tx FIFO is empty and the
Tx interrupt is enabled, except in the following
instance. Assume that the Tx FIFO is empty
and the CPU starts to load it. When the first
byte enters the FIFO the Tx FIFO empty
interrupt will transition from active to inactive.
Depending on the execution speed of the service
routine software, the UART may be able to
transfer this byte from the FIFO to the shift
register before the CPU loads another byte. If
this happens, the Tx FIFO will be empty again
and typically the UART's interrupt line would
transition to the active state. This could cause a
system with an interrupt control unit to record a
Tx FIFO empty condition, even though the CPU
is currently servicing that interrupt. Therefore,
after the first byte has been loaded into the
FIFO the UART will wait one serial character
transmission time before issuing a new Tx
FIFO empty interrupt. This one character Tx
interrupt delay will remain active until at
least two bytes have the Tx FIFO empties
after this condition, the Tx been loaded into
the FIFO, concurrently. When interrupt will
be activated without a one character delay.
Rx support functions and operation are quite
different from those described for the
transmitter. The Rx FIFO receives data until the
number of bytes in the FIFO equals the selected
interrupt trigger level. At that time if Rx
interrupts are enabled, the UART will issue an
interrupt to the CPU. The Rx FIFO will continue
to store bytes until it holds 16 of them. It will
not accept any more data when it is full. Any
more data entering the Rx shift register will set
the Overrun Error flag. Normally, the FIFO
depth and the programmable trigger levels will
give the CPU ample time to empty the Rx FIFO
before an overrun occurs.

One side-effect of having a Rx FIFO is that the
selected interrupt trigger level may be above the
data level in the FIFO. This could occur when
data at the end of the block contains fewer bytes
than the trigger level. No interrupt would be
issued to the CPU and the data would remain in
the UART. To prevent the software from
having to check for this situation the chip
incorporates a timeout interrupt.

The timeout interrupt is activated when there is
a least one byte in the Rx FIFO, and neither the
CPU nor the Rx shift register has accessed the
Rx FIFO within 4 character times of the last
byte. The timeout interrupt is cleared or reset
when the CPU reads the Rx FIFO or another
character enters it.

These FIFO related features allow optimization
of CPU/UART transactions and are especially
useful given the higher baud rate capability (256
kbaud).
Ring Wake Filter

An optional filter is provided to prevent glitches
to the wakeup circuitry and prevent unnecessary
wakeup of the system when a phone is picked
up or hung up. If enabled, this filter will be
placed into the soft power management, SMI
and PME/SCI wakeup event path of either of the
UART ring indicator pins (nRI1, nRI2), or the
84
nRING pin, which is an alternate function on
GP11 and GP62.
This feature is enabled onto the nRING pin or
one of the ring indicator pins (nRI1, nRI2) via
the Ring Filter Select Register defined below. If
enabled, a frequency detection filter is placed in
the path to the soft power management block,
SMI and PME interface that generates an active
low pulse for the duration of a signal that
produces 3 edges in a 200msec time period i.e.,
detects a pulse train of frequency 15Hz or
higher.
This filter circuit runs off of the 32 kHz clock.
This circuit is powered by the VTR power
supply. When this circuit is disabled, it will draw
no current.
The nRING function is part of the soft power
management block as an additional wakeup
event, and the SMI and PME interface logic.
1. A status and enable bit is in the soft power
status and enable registers as follows:
·
RING Status bit - R/W: RING_STS, Bit 3 of
Soft Power Status Register 2 (Logical
Device 8, 0xB3); latched, cleared on read.
1= Ring indicator input occurred on the
nRING pin and, if enabled, caused the
wakeup (activated nPowerOn). 0= nRING
input did not occur.
·
RING Enable bit - R/W: RING_EN, Bit 3 of
Soft Power Enable Register 2 (Logical
Device 8, 0xB1). 1=Enable ring indication
on nRING pin as wakeup function to
activate nPowerOn. 0=Disable.
2. An enable bit is in the SMI Enable Register
1 as follows:
·
RING Enable bit - R/W: RING_EN, Bit 0 of
SMI Register 1 (System I/O Space, at
<PM1_BLK>+14h). 1=Enable ring
indication on nRING pin as SMI function.
0=Disable. Note: The PME status bit for
RING is used as the SMI status bit for
RING (see PME Status Register).
3. A status and enable bit is in the PME status
and enable registers as follows:
·
RING Status bit - R/W: RING_STS, Bit 5 of
PME Status Register 1 (System I/O Space,
at <PM1_BLK>+Ch); latched, cleared by
writing a "1" to this bit. 1= Ring indicator
input occurred on the nRING pin and, if
enabled, caused the nPME/SCI or SMI. 0=
nRING input did not occur.
·
RING Enable bit - R/W: RING_EN, Bit 5 of
PME Enable Register 1 (System I/O Space,
at <PM1_BLK>+Eh). 1=Enable ring
indication on nRING pin as PME wakeup
function. 0=Disable.

Refer to Logical Device 8, 0xC6 for
programming information
The ring wakeup filter will produce an active low
pulse for the period of time that nRING, nRI1
and/or nRI2 is toggling. See figure below.
85
FIGURE 3 - RING WAKEUP FILTER OUTPUT

INFRARED INTERFACE

The infrared interface provides a two-way
wireless communications port using infrared as
a transmission medium. Several IR
implementations have been provided for the
second UART in this chip (logical device 5),
IrDA 1.0 and Amplitude Shift Keyed IR. The IR
transmission can use the standard UART2
TXD2 and RXD2 pins or optional IRTX and
IRRX pins. These can be selected through the
configuration registers.

IrDA 1.0 allows serial communication at baud
rates up to 115.2 kbps. Each word is sent
serially beginning with a zero value start bit. A
zero is signaled by sending a single IR pulse at
the beginning of the serial bit time. A one is
signaled by sending no IR pulse during the bit
time. Please refer to the AC timing for the
parameters of these pulses and the IrDA
waveform.

The Amplitude Shift Keyed IR allows
asynchronous serial communication at baud
rates up to 19.2K Baud. Each word is sent
serially beginning with a zero value start bit. A
zero is signaled by sending a 500KHz waveform
for the duration of the serial bit time. A one is
signaled by sending no transmission during the
bit time. Please refer to the AC timing for the
parameters of the ASK-IR waveform.
If the Half-Duplex option is chosen, there is a
time-out when the direction of the transmission
is changed. This time-out starts at the last bit
transferred during a transmission and blocks the
receiver input until the timeout expires. If the
transmit buffer is loaded with more data before
the time-out expires, the timer is restarted after
the new byte is transmitted. If data is loaded
into the transmit buffer while a character is
being received, the transmission will not start
until the time-out expires after the last receive
bit has been received. If the start bit of another
character is received during this time-out, the
timer is restarted after the new character is
received. The IR half-duplex time-out is
programmable via CRF2 in Logical Device 5.
This register allows the time-out to be
programmed to any value between 0 and
10msec in 100usec increments.
n R I N G
R i n g W a k e u p F i l t e r O u t p u t
86
PARALLEL PORT

This chip incorporates an IBM XT/AT compatible
parallel port. This supports the optional PS/2
type bi-directional parallel port (SPP), the
Enhanced Parallel Port (EPP) and the Extended
Capabilities Port (ECP) parallel port modes.
Refer to the Configuration Registers for
information on disabling, power down, changing
the base address of the parallel port, and
selecting the mode of operation.

This chip also provides a mode for support of
the floppy disk controller on the parallel port.
The parallel port also incorporates SMSC's
ChiProtect circuitry, which prevents possible
damage to the parallel port due to printer power-
up.
The functionality of the Parallel Port is achieved
through the use of eight addressable ports, with
their associated registers and control gating.
The control and data port are read/write by the
CPU, the status port is read/write in the EPP
mode. The address map of the Parallel Port is
shown below:

DATA PORT
BASE ADDRESS + 00H
STATUS PORT
BASE ADDRESS + 01H
CONTROL PORT
BASE ADDRESS + 02H
EPP ADDR PORT
BASE ADDRESS + 03H
EPP DATA PORT 0
BASE ADDRESS + 04H
EPP DATA PORT 1
BASE ADDRESS + 05H
EPP DATA PORT 2
BASE ADDRESS + 06H
EPP DATA PORT 3
BASE ADDRESS + 07H

The bit map of these registers is:
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note
DATA PORT
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
1
STATUS
PORT
TMOUT
0
0
nERR
SLCT
PE
nACK
nBUSY
1
CONTROL
PORT
STROBE
AUTOFD
nINIT
SLC
IRQE
PCD
0
0
1
EPP ADDR
PORT
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
AD7
2,3
EPP DATA
PORT 0
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
2,3
EPP DATA
PORT 1
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
2,3
EPP DATA
PORT 2
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
2,3
EPP DATA
PORT 3
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
2,3
Note 1: These registers are available in all modes.
Note 2: These registers are only available in EPP mode.
Note 3: For EPP mode, IOCHRDY must be connected to the ISA bus.
87
TABLE 38 - PARALLEL PORT CONNECTOR
HOST
CONNECTOR
PIN NUMBER
STANDARD
EPP
ECP
1
111
nStrobe
nWrite
nStrobe
2-9
96-103
PData<0:7>
PData<0:7>
PData<0:7>
10
108
nAck
Intr
nAck
11
107
Busy
nWait
Busy, PeriphAck(3)
12
106
PE
(NU)
PError,
nAckReverse(3)
13
105
Select
(NU)
Select
14
110
nAutofd
nDatastb
nAutoFd,
HostAck(3)
15
109
nError
(NU)
nFault(1)
nPeriphRequest(3)
16
94
nInit
(NU)
nInit(1)
nReverseRqst(3)
17
95
nSelectin
nAddrstrb
nSelectIn(1,3)

(1) = Compatible Mode
(3) = High Speed Mode

Note:
For the cable interconnection required for ECP support and the Slave Connector pin
numbers, refer to the IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Standard, Rev.
1.14, July 14, 1993. This document is available from Microsoft.
88
IBM XT/AT COMPATIBLE, BI-
DIRECTIONAL AND EPP MODES

DATA PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 00H

The Data Port is located at an offset of '00H'
from the base address. The data register is
cleared at initialization by RESET. During a
WRITE operation, the Data Register latches the
contents of the data bus with the rising edge of
the nIOW input. The contents of this register
are buffered (non inverting) and output onto the
PD0 - PD7 ports. During a READ operation in
SPP mode, PD0 - PD7 ports are buffered (not
latched) and output to the host CPU.

STATUS PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 01H

The Status Port is located at an offset of '01H'
from the base address. The contents of this
register are latched for the duration of an nIOR
read cycle. The bits of the Status Port are
defined as follows:

BIT 0 TMOUT - TIME OUT
This bit is valid in EPP mode only and indicates
that a 10 usec time out has occurred on the
EPP bus. A logic O means that no time out
error has occurred; a logic 1 means that a time
out error has been detected. This bit is cleared
by a RESET. Writing a one to this bit clears the
time out status bit. On a write, this bit is self
clearing and does not require a write of a zero.
Writing a zero to this bit has no effect.

BITS 1, 2 - are not implemented as register bits,
during a read of the Printer Status Register
these bits are a low level.

BIT 3 nERR - nERROR
The level on the nERROR input is read by the
CPU as bit 3 of the Printer Status Register. A
logic 0 means an error has been detected; a
logic 1 means no error has been detected.
BIT 4 SLCT - PRINTER SELECTED STATUS
The level on the SLCT input is read by the CPU
as bit 4 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 1
means the printer is on line; a logic 0 means it is
not selected.

BIT 5 PE - PAPER END
The level on the PE input is read by the CPU as
bit 5 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 1
indicates a paper end; a logic 0 indicates the
presence of paper.

BIT 6 nACK - nACKNOWLEDGE
The level on the nACK input is read by the CPU
as bit 6 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 0
means that the printer has received a character
and can now accept another. A logic 1 means
that it is still processing the last character or has
not received the data.

BIT 7 nBUSY - nBUSY
The complement of the level on the BUSY input
is read by the CPU as bit 7 of the Printer Status
Register. A logic 0 in this bit means that the
printer is busy and cannot accept a new
character. A logic 1 means that it is ready to
accept the next character.

CONTROL PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 02H

The Control Port is located at an offset of '02H'
from the base address. The Control Register is
initialized by the RESET input, bits 0 to 5 only
being affected; bits 6 and 7 are hard wired low.

BIT 0 STROBE - STROBE
This bit is inverted and output onto the
nSTROBE output.

BIT 1 AUTOFD - AUTOFEED
This bit is inverted and output onto the
nAUTOFD output. A logic 1 causes the printer
to generate a line feed after each line is printed.
A logic 0 means no autofeed.
89
BIT 2 nINIT - nINITIATE OUTPUT
This bit is output onto the nINIT output without
inversion.

BIT 3 SLCTIN - PRINTER SELECT INPUT
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSLCTIN
output. A logic 1 on this bit selects the printer; a
logic 0 means the printer is not selected.

BIT 4 IRQE - INTERRUPT REQUEST ENABLE
The interrupt request enable bit when set to a
high level may be used to enable interrupt
requests from the Parallel Port to the CPU. An
interrupt request is generated on the IRQ port by
a positive going nACK input. When the IRQE
bit is programmed low the IRQ is disabled.

BIT 5 PCD - PARALLEL CONTROL
DIRECTION
Parallel Control Direction is not valid in printer
mode. In printer mode, the direction is always
out regardless of the state of this bit. In bi-
directional, EPP or ECP mode, a logic 0 means
that the printer port is in output mode (write); a
logic 1 means that the printer port is in input
mode (read).

Bits 6 and 7 during a read are a low level, and
cannot be written.

EPP ADDRESS PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 03H

The EPP Address Port is located at an offset of
'03H' from the base address. The address
register is cleared at initialization by RESET.
During a WRITE operation, the contents of DB0-
DB7 are buffered (non inverting) and output onto
the PD0 - PD7 ports, the leading edge of nIOW
causes an EPP ADDRESS WRITE cycle to be
performed, the trailing edge of IOW latches the
data for the duration of the EPP write cycle.
During a READ operation, PD0 - PD7 ports are
read, the leading edge of IOR causes an EPP
ADDRESS READ cycle to be performed and the
data output to the host CPU, the deassertion of
ADDRSTB latches the PData for the duration of
the IOR cycle. This register is only available in
EPP mode.

EPP DATA PORT 0
ADDRESS OFFSET = 04H

The EPP Data Port 0 is located at an offset of
'04H' from the base address. The data register
is cleared at initialization by RESET. During a
WRITE operation, the contents of DB0-DB7 are
buffered (non inverting) and output onto the PD0
- PD7 ports, the leading edge of nIOW causes
an EPP DATA WRITE cycle to be performed,
the trailing edge of IOW latches the data for the
duration of the EPP write cycle. During a READ
operation, PD0 - PD7 ports are read, the leading
edge of IOR causes an EPP READ cycle to be
performed and the data output to the host CPU,
the deassertion of DATASTB latches the PData
for the duration of the IOR cycle. This register
is only available in EPP mode.

EPP DATA PORT 1
ADDRESS OFFSET = 05H

The EPP Data Port 1 is located at an offset of
'05H' from the base address. Refer to EPP
DATA PORT 0 for a description of operation.
This register is only available in EPP mode.

EPP DATA PORT 2
ADDRESS OFFSET = 06H

The EPP Data Port 2 is located at an offset of
'06H' from the base address. Refer to EPP
DATA PORT 0 for a description of operation.
This register is only available in EPP mode.

EPP DATA PORT 3
ADDRESS OFFSET = 07H

The EPP Data Port 3 is located at an offset of
'07H' from the base address. Refer to EPP
DATA PORT 0 for a description of operation.
This register is only available in EPP mode.
90
EPP 1.9 OPERATION

When the EPP mode is selected in the
configuration register, the standard and bi-
directional modes are also available. If no EPP
Read, Write or Address cycle is currently
executing, then the PDx bus is in the standard or
bi-directional mode, and all output signals
(STROBE, AUTOFD, INIT) are as set by the
SPP Control Port and direction is controlled by
PCD of the Control port.

In EPP mode, the system timing is closely
coupled to the EPP timing. For this reason, a
watchdog timer is required to prevent system
lockup. The timer indicates if more than 10usec
have elapsed from the start of the EPP cycle
(nIOR or nIOW asserted) to nWAIT being
deasserted (after command). If a time-out
occurs, the current EPP cycle is aborted and the
time-out condition is indicated in Status bit 0.

During an EPP cycle, if STROBE is active, it
overrides the EPP write signal forcing the PDx
bus to always be in a write mode and the
nWRITE signal to always be asserted.

Software Constraints

Before an EPP cycle is executed, the software
must ensure that the control register bit PCD is
a logic "0" (ie a 04H or 05H should be written to
the Control port). If the user leaves PCD as a
logic "1", and attempts to perform an EPP write,
the chip is unable to perform the write (because
PCD is a logic "1") and will appear to perform an
EPP read on the parallel bus, no error is
indicated.

EPP 1.9 Write

The timing for a write operation (address or
data) is shown in timing diagram EPP Write
Data or Address cycle. IOCHRDY is driven
active low at the start of each EPP write and is
released when it has been determined that the
write cycle can complete. The write cycle can
complete under the following circumstances:
1.
If the EPP bus is not ready (nWAIT is active
low) when nDATASTB or nADDRSTB goes
active then the write can complete when
nWAIT goes inactive high.
2.
If the EPP bus is ready (nWAIT is inactive
high) then the chip must wait for it to go
active low before changing the state of
nDATASTB, nWRITE or nADDRSTB. The
write can complete once nWAIT is
determined inactive.

Write Sequence of operation

1.
The host selects an EPP register, places
data on the SData bus and drives nIOW
active.
2.
The chip drives IOCHRDY inactive (low).
3.
If WAIT is not asserted, the chip must wait
until WAIT is asserted.
4.
The chip places address or data on PData
bus, clears PDIR, and asserts nWRITE.
5.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB
indicating that PData bus contains valid
information, and the WRITE signal is valid.
6.
Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating that
any setup requirements have been satisfied
and the chip may begin the termination
phase of the cycle.
7.
a)
The chip deasserts nDATASTB or
nADDRSTRB, this marks the beginning
of the termination phase. If it has not
already done so, the peripheral should
latch the information byte now.
b)
The chip latches the data from the
SData bus for the PData bus and
asserts (releases) IOCHRDY allowing
the host to complete the write cycle.
8.
Peripheral asserts nWAIT, indicating to the
host that any hold time requirements have
been satisfied and acknowledging the
termination of the cycle.
9.
Chip may modify nWRITE and nPDATA in
preparation for the next cycle.
91
EPP 1.9 Read

The timing for a read operation (data) is shown
in timing diagram EPP Read Data cycle.
IOCHRDY is driven active low at the start of
each EPP read and is released when it has been
determined that the read cycle can complete.
The read cycle can complete under the following
circumstances:

1
If the EPP bus is not ready (nWAIT is active
low) when nDATASTB goes active then the
read can complete when nWAIT goes
inactive high.
2.
If the EPP bus is ready (nWAIT is inactive
high) then the chip must wait for it to go
active low before changing the state of
WRITE or before nDATASTB goes active.
The read can complete once nWAIT is
determined inactive.

Read Sequence of Operation

1.
The host selects an EPP register and drives
nIOR active.
2.
The chip drives IOCHRDY inactive (low).
3.
If WAIT is not asserted, the chip must wait
until WAIT is asserted.
4.
The chip tri-states the PData bus and
deasserts nWRITE.
5.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB
indicating that PData bus is tri-stated, PDIR
is set and the nWRITE signal is valid.
6.
Peripheral drives PData bus valid.
7.
Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating that
PData is valid and the chip may begin the
termination phase of the cycle.
8. a)
The chip latches the data from the
PData bus for the SData bus and
deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB.
This marks the beginning of the
termination phase.
b)
The chip drives the valid data onto the
SData bus and asserts (releases)
IOCHRDY allowing the host to
complete the read cycle.
9.
Peripheral tri-states the PData bus and
asserts nWAIT, indicating to the host that
the PData bus is tri-stated.
10. Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and
nPDATA in preparation for the next cycle.

EPP 1.7 OPERATION

When the EPP 1.7 mode is selected in the
configuration register, the standard and bi-
directional modes are also available. If no EPP
Read, Write or Address cycle is currently
executing, then the PDx bus is in the standard or
bi-directional mode, and all output signals
(STROBE, AUTOFD, INIT) are as set by the
SPP Control Port and direction is controlled by
PCD of the Control port.


In EPP mode, the system timing is closely
coupled to the EPP timing. For this reason, a
watchdog timer is required to prevent system
lockup. The timer indicates if more than 10usec
have elapsed from the start of the EPP cycle
(nIOR or nIOW asserted) to the end of the cycle
nIOR or nIOW deasserted). If a time-out
occurs, the current EPP cycle is aborted and the
time-out condition is indicated in Status bit 0.

Software Constraints

Before an EPP cycle is executed, the software
must ensure that the control register bits D0, D1
and D3 are set to zero. Also, bit D5 (PCD) is a
logic "0" for an EPP write or a logic "1" for and
EPP read.

EPP 1.7 Write

The timing for a write operation (address or
data) is shown in timing diagram EPP 1.7 Write
Data or Address cycle. IOCHRDY is driven
active low when nWAIT is active low during the
EPP cycle. This can be used to extend the cycle
time. The write cycle can complete when
nWAIT is inactive high.
92
Write Sequence of Operation

1.
The host sets PDIR bit in the control
register to a logic "0". This asserts
nWRITE.
2.
The host selects an EPP register, places
data on the SData bus and drives nIOW
active.
3.
The chip places address or data on PData
bus.
4.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB
indicating that PData bus contains valid
information, and the WRITE signal is valid.
5.
If nWAIT is asserted, IOCHRDY is
deasserted until the peripheral deasserts
nWAIT or a time-out occurs.
6. When the host deasserts nIOW the chip
deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB and
latches the data from the SData bus for the
PData bus.
7.
Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and
nPDATA in preparation of the next cycle.

EPP 1.7 Read

The timing for a read operation (data) is shown
in timing diagram EPP 1.7 Read Data cycle.
IOCHRDY is driven active low when nWAIT is
active low during the EPP cycle. This can be
used to extend the cycle time. The read cycle
can complete when nWAIT is inactive high.

Read Sequence of Operation

1.
The host sets PDIR bit in the control
register to a logic "1". This deasserts
nWRITE and tri-states the PData bus.
2.
The host selects an EPP register and drives
nIOR active.
3.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB
indicating that PData bus is tri-stated, PDIR
is set and the nWRITE signal is valid.
4.
If nWAIT is asserted, IOCHRDY is
deasserted until the peripheral deasserts
nWAIT or a time-out occurs.
5.
The Peripheral drives PData bus valid.
6.
The Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating
that PData is valid and the chip may begin
the termination phase of the cycle.
7. When the host deasserts nIOR the chip
deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB.
8.
Peripheral tri-states the PData bus.
9.
Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and
nPDATA in preparation of the next cycle.
93
TABLE 39 - EPP PIN DESCRIPTIONS
EPP
SIGNAL
EPP NAME
TYPE
EPP DESCRIPTION
nWRITE
nWrite
O
This signal is active low. It denotes a write operation.
PD<0:7>
Address/Data
I/O
Bi-directional EPP byte wide address and data bus.
INTR
Interrupt
I
This signal is active high and positive edge triggered. (Pass
through with no inversion, Same as SPP).
WAIT
nWait
I
This signal is active low. It is driven inactive as a positive
acknowledgement from the device that the transfer of data is
completed. It is driven active as an indication that the
device is ready for the next transfer.
DATASTB
nData Strobe
O
This signal is active low. It is used to denote data read or
write operation.
RESET
nReset
O
This signal is active low. When driven active, the EPP
device is reset to its initial operational mode.
ADDRSTB
nAddress
Strobe
O
This signal is active low. It is used to denote address read
or write operation.
PE
Paper End
I
Same as SPP mode.
SLCT
Printer
Selected
Status
I
Same as SPP mode.
nERR
Error
I
Same as SPP mode.
PDIR
Parallel Port
Direction
O
This output shows the direction of the data transfer on the
parallel port bus. A low means an output/write condition and
a high means an input/read condition. This signal is
normally a low (output/write) unless PCD of the control
register is set or if an EPP read cycle is in progress.

Note 1: SPP and EPP can use 1 common register.
Note 2: nWrite is the only EPP output that can be over-ridden by SPP control port during an EPP
cycle. For correct EPP read cycles, PCD is required to be a low.
94
EXTENDED CAPABILITIES PARALLEL PORT

ECP provides a number of advantages, some of
which are listed below. The individual features
are explained in greater detail in the remainder
of this section.
·
High performance half-duplex forward and
reverse channel
·
Interlocked handshake, for fast reliable
transfer
·
Optional single byte RLE compression for
improved throughput (64:1)
·
Channel addressing for low-cost peripherals
·
Maintains link and data layer separation
·
Permits the use of active output drivers
·
Permits the use of adaptive signal timing
·
Peer-to-peer capability

Vocabulary
The following terms are used in this document:

assert:
When a signal asserts it transitions to a
"true" state, when a signal deasserts it
transitions to a "false" state.
forward: Host to Peripheral communication.
reverse: Peripheral to Host communication
Pword: A port word; equal in size to the width
of the ISA interface. For this
implementation, PWord is always 8
bits.
1
A high level.
0
A low level.

These terms may be considered synonymous:
·
PeriphClk, nAck
·
HostAck, nAutoFd
·
PeriphAck, Busy
·
nPeriphRequest, nFault
·
nReverseRequest, nInit
·
nAckReverse, PError
·
Xflag, Select
·
ECPMode, nSelectln
·
HostClk, nStrobe

Reference Document: IEEE 1284 Extended
Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Interface
Standard, Rev 1.14, July 14, 1993. This
document is available from Microsoft.

The bit map of the Extended Parallel Port
registers is:
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Note
data
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
ecpAFifo
Addr/RLE
Address or RLE field
2
dsr
nBusy
nAck
PError
Select
nFault
0
0
0
1
dcr
0
0
Direction
ackIntEn
SelectIn
nInit
autofd
strobe
1
cFifo
Parallel Port Data FIFO
2
ecpDFifo
ECP Data FIFO
2
tFifo
Test FIFO
2
cnfgA
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
cnfgB
compress
intrValue
Parallel Port IRQ
Parallel Port DMA
ecr
MODE
nErrIntrEn
dmaEn
serviceIntr
full
empty
Note 1: These registers are available in all modes.
Note 2: All FIFOs use one common 16 byte FIFO.
Note 3: The ECP Parallel Port Config Reg B reflects the IRQ and DRQ selected by the Configuration
Registers.
95
ISA IMPLEMENTATION STANDARD

This specification describes the standard ISA
interface to the Extended Capabilities Port
(ECP). All ISA devices supporting ECP must
meet the requirements contained in this section
or the port will not be supported by Microsoft.
For a description of the ECP Protocol, please
refer to the IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities
Port Protocol and ISA Interface Standard, Rev.
1.14, July 14, 1993. This document is available
from Microsoft.

Description

The port is software and hardware compatible
with existing parallel ports so that it may be
used as a standard LPT port if ECP is not
required. The port is designed to be simple and
requires a small number of gates to implement.
It does not do any "protocol" negotiation, rather
it provides an automatic high burst-bandwidth
channel that supports DMA for ECP in both the
forward and reverse directions.

Small FIFOs are employed in both forward and
reverse directions to smooth data flow and
improve the maximum bandwidth requirement.
The size of the FIFO is 16 bytes deep. The port
supports an automatic handshake for the
standard parallel port to improve compatibility
mode transfer speed.

The port also supports run length encoded
(RLE) decompression (required) in hardware.
Compression is accomplished by counting
identical bytes and transmitting an RLE byte
that indicates how many times the next byte is
to be repeated. Decompression simply
intercepts the RLE byte and repeats the
following byte the specified number of times.
Hardware support for compression is optional.
96
TABLE 40 - ECP PIN DESCRIPTIONS
NAME
TYPE
DESCRIPTION
nStrobe
O
During write operations nStrobe registers data or address into the slave
on the asserting edge (handshakes with Busy).
PData 7:0
I/O
Contains address or data or RLE data.
nAck
I
Indicates valid data driven by the peripheral when asserted. This signal
handshakes with nAutoFd in reverse.
PeriphAck (Busy)
I
This signal deasserts to indicate that the peripheral can accept data.
This signal handshakes with nStrobe in the forward direction. In the
reverse direction this signal indicates whether the data lines contain
ECP command information or data. The peripheral uses this signal to
flow control in the forward direction. It is an "interlocked" handshake
with nStrobe. PeriphAck also provides command information in the
reverse direction.
PError
(nAckReverse)
I
Used to acknowledge a change in the direction the transfer (asserted =
forward). The peripheral drives this signal low to acknowledge
nReverseRequest. It is an "interlocked" handshake with
nReverseRequest. The host relies upon nAckReverse to determine
when it is permitted to drive the data bus.
Select
I
Indicates printer on line.
nAutoFd
(HostAck)
O
Requests a byte of data from the peripheral when asserted,
handshaking with nAck in the reverse direction. In the forward direction
this signal indicates whether the data lines contain ECP address or
data. The host drives this signal to flow control in the reverse direction.
It is an "interlocked" handshake with nAck. HostAck also provides
command information in the forward phase.
nFault
(nPeriphRequest)
I
Generates an error interrupt when asserted. This signal provides a
mechanism for peer-to-peer communication. This signal is valid only in
the forward direction. During ECP Mode the peripheral is permitted
(but not required) to drive this pin low to request a reverse transfer. The
request is merely a "hint" to the host; the host has ultimate control over
the transfer direction. This signal would be typically used to generate
an interrupt to the host CPU.
nInit
O
Sets the transfer direction (asserted = reverse, deasserted = forward).
This pin is driven low to place the channel in the reverse direction. The
peripheral is only allowed to drive the bi-directional data bus while in
ECP Mode and HostAck is low and nSelectIn is high.
nSelectIn
O
Always deasserted in ECP mode.
97
Register Definitions

The register definitions are based on the
standard IBM addresses for LPT. All of the
standard printer ports are supported. The
additional registers attach to an upper bit
decode of the standard LPT port definition to
avoid conflict with standard ISA devices. The
port is equivalent to a generic parallel port
interface and may be operated in that mode.
The port registers vary depending on the mode
field in the ecr. The table below lists these
dependencies. Operation of the devices in
modes other that those specified is undefined.
TABLE 41 - ECP REGISTER DEFINITIONS
NAME
ADDRESS (Note 1)
ECP MODES
FUNCTION
data
+000h R/W
000-001
Data Register
ecpAFifo
+000h R/W
011
ECP FIFO (Address)
dsr
+001h R/W
All
Status Register
dcr
+002h R/W
All
Control Register
cFifo
+400h R/W
010
Parallel Port Data FIFO
ecpDFifo
+400h R/W
011
ECP FIFO (DATA)
tFifo
+400h R/W
110
Test FIFO
cnfgA
+400h R
111
Configuration Register A
cnfgB
+401h R/W
111
Configuration Register B
ecr
+402h R/W
All
Extended Control Register
Note 1: These addresses are added to the parallel port base address as selected by configuration
register or jumpers.
Note 2: All addresses are qualified with AEN. Refer to the AEN pin definition.
TABLE 42 - MODE DESCRIPTIONS
MODE
DESCRIPTION*
000
SPP mode
001
PS/2 Parallel Port mode
010
Parallel Port Data FIFO mode
011
ECP Parallel Port mode
100
EPP mode (If this option is enabled in the configuration registers)
101
Reserved
110
Test mode
111
Configuration mode
*Refer to ECR Register Description

98
DATA and ecpAFifo PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 00H

Modes 000 and 001 (Data Port)

The Data Port is located at an offset of '00H'
from the base address. The data register is
cleared at initialization by RESET. During a
WRITE operation, the Data Register latches the
contents of the data bus on the rising edge of
the nIOW input. The contents of this register
are buffered (non inverting) and output onto the
PD0 - PD7 ports. During a READ operation,
PD0 - PD7 ports are read and output to the host
CPU.

Mode 011 (ECP FIFO - Address/RLE)

A data byte written to this address is placed in
the FIFO and tagged as an ECP Address/RLE.
The hardware at the ECP port transmits this
byte to the peripheral automatically. The
operation of this register is ony defined for the
forward direction (direction is 0). Refer to the
ECP Parallel Port Forward Timing Diagram,
located in the Timing Diagrams section of this
data sheet .

DEVICE STATUS REGISTER (dsr)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 01H

The Status Port is located at an offset of '01H'
from the base address. Bits 0 - 2 are not
implemented as register bits, during a read of
the Printer Status Register these bits are a low
level. The bits of the Status Port are defined as
follows:
BIT 3 nFault
The level on the nFault input is read by the CPU
as bit 3 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 4 Select
The level on the Select input is read by the CPU
as bit 4 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 5 PError
The level on the PError input is read by the CPU
as bit 5 of the Device Status Register. Printer
Status Register.
BIT 6 nAck
The level on the nAck input is read by the CPU
as bit 6 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 7 nBusy
The complement of the level on the BUSY input
is read by the CPU as bit 7 of the Device Status
Register.

DEVICE CONTROL REGISTER (dcr)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 02H

The Control Register is located at an offset of
'02H' from the base address. The Control
Register is initialized to zero by the RESET
input, bits 0 to 5 only being affected; bits 6 and
7 are hard wired low.
BIT 0 STROBE - STROBE
This bit is inverted and output onto the
nSTROBE output.
BIT 1 AUTOFD - AUTOFEED
This bit is inverted and output onto the
nAUTOFD output. A logic 1 causes the printer
to generate a line feed after each line is printed.
A logic 0 means no autofeed.
BIT 2 nINIT - nINITIATE OUTPUT
This bit is output onto the nINIT output without
inversion.
BIT 3 SELECTIN
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSLCTIN
output. A logic 1 on this bit selects the printer; a
logic 0 means the printer is not selected.
BIT 4 ackIntEn - INTERRUPT REQUEST
ENABLE
The interrupt request enable bit when set to a
high level may be used to enable interrupt
requests from the Parallel Port to the CPU due
to a low to high transition on the nACK input.
Refer to the description of the interrupt under
Operation, Interrupts.
BIT 5 DIRECTION
If mode=000 or mode=010, this bit has no effect
and the direction is always out regardless of the
state of this bit. In all other modes, Direction is
valid and a logic 0 means that the printer port is
in output mode (write); a logic 1 means that the
printer port is in input mode (read).
99
BITS 6 and 7 during a read are a low level, and
cannot be written.

cFifo (Parallel Port Data FIFO)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400h
Mode = 010

Bytes written or DMAed from the system to this
FIFO are transmitted by a hardware handshake
to the peripheral using the standard parallel port
protocol. Transfers to the FIFO are byte
aligned. This mode is only defined for the
forward direction.

ecpDFifo (ECP Data FIFO)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 011

Bytes written or DMAed from the system to this
FIFO, when the direction bit is 0, are transmitted
by a hardware handshake to the peripheral
using the ECP parallel port protocol. Transfers
to the FIFO are byte aligned.

Data bytes from the peripheral are read under
automatic hardware handshake from ECP into
this FIFO when the direction bit is 1. Reads or
DMAs from the FIFO will return bytes of ECP
data to the system.

tFifo (Test FIFO Mode)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 110

Data bytes may be read, written or DMAed to or
from the system to this FIFO in any direction.
Data in the tFIFO will not be transmitted to the
to the parallel port lines using a hardware
protocol handshake. However, data in the
tFIFO may be displayed on the parallel port data
lines.

The tFIFO will not stall when overwritten or
underrun. If an attempt is made to write data to
a full tFIFO, the new data is not accepted into
the tFIFO. If an attempt is made to read data
from an empty tFIFO, the last data byte is re-
read again. The full and empty bits must
always keep track of the correct FIFO state. The
tFIFO will transfer data at the maximum ISA
rate so that software may generate performance
metrics.

The FIFO size and interrupt threshold can be
determined by writing bytes to the FIFO and
checking the full and serviceIntr bits.

The writeIntrThreshold can be determined by
starting with a full tFIFO, setting the direction bit
to 0 and emptying it a byte at a time until
serviceIntr is set. This may generate a spurious
interrupt, but will indicate that the threshold has
been reached.

The readIntrThreshold can be determined by
setting the direction bit to 1 and filling the empty
tFIFO a byte at a time until serviceIntr is set.
This may generate a spurious interrupt, but will
indicate that the threshold has been reached.

Data bytes are always read from the head of
tFIFO regardless of the value of the direction bit.
For example if 44h, 33h, 22h is written to the
FIFO, then reading the tFIFO will return 44h,
33h, 22h in the same order as was written.

cnfgA (Configuration Register A)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 111

This register is a read only register. When read,
10H is returned. This indicates to the system
that this is an 8-bit implementation. (PWord = 1
byte)

cnfgB (Configuration Register B)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 401H
Mode = 111

BIT 7 compress
This bit is read only. During a read it is a low
level. This means that this chip does not
support hardware RLE compression. It does
support hardware de-compression!
100
BIT 6 intrValue
Returns the value on the ISA IRq line to
determine possible conflicts.
BITS [5:3] Parallel Port IRQ (read-only)
Refer to Table 39B.
BITS [2:0] Parallel Port DMA (read-only)
Refer to Table 39C.

ecr (Extended Control Register)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 402H
Mode = all
This register controls the extended ECP parallel
port functions.
BITS 7,6,5
These bits are Read/Write and select the Mode.
BIT 4 nErrIntrEn
Read/Write (Valid only in ECP Mode)
1:
Disables the interrupt generated on the
asserting edge of nFault.
0:
Enables an interrupt pulse on the high to
low edge of nFault. Note that an interrupt
will be generated if nFault is asserted
(interrupting) and this bit is written from a 1
to a 0. This prevents interrupts from being
lost in the time between the read of the ecr
and the write of the ecr.
BIT 3 dmaEn
Read/Write
1:
Enables DMA (DMA starts when serviceIntr
is 0).
0:
Disables DMA unconditionally.
BIT 2 serviceIntr
Read/Write
1:
Disables DMA and all of the service
interrupts.
0:
Enables one of the following 3 cases of
interrupts. Once one of the 3 service
interrupts has occurred serviceIntr bit shall
be set to a 1 by hardware. It must be reset
to 0 to re-enable the interrupts. Writing this
bit to a 1 will not cause an interrupt.
case dmaEn=1:
During DMA (this bit is set to a 1 when
terminal count is reached).
case dmaEn=0 direction=0:
This bit shall be set to 1 whenever there are
writeIntrThreshold or more bytes free in the
FIFO.
case dmaEn=0 direction=1:
This bit shall be set to 1 whenever there are
readIntrThreshold or more valid bytes to be
read from the FIFO.
BIT 1 full
Read only
1:
The FIFO cannot accept another byte or the
FIFO is completely full.
0:
The FIFO has at least 1 free byte.
BIT 0 empty
Read only
1:
The FIFO is completely empty.
0:
The FIFO contains at least 1 byte of data.
101
TABLE 43 - EXTENDED CONTROL REGISTER
R/W
MODE
000:
Standard Parallel Port Mode . In this mode the FIFO is reset and common collector drivers
are used on the control lines (nStrobe, nAutoFd, nInit and nSelectIn). Setting the direction
bit will not tri-state the output drivers in this mode.
001:
PS/2 Parallel Port Mode. Same as above except that direction may be used to tri-state the
data lines and reading the data register returns the value on the data lines and not the
value in the data register. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
010:
Parallel Port FIFO Mode. This is the same as 000 except that bytes are written or DMAed to
the FIFO. FIFO data is automatically transmitted using the standard parallel port protocol.
Note that this mode is only useful when direction is 0. All drivers have active pull-ups
(push-pull).
011:
ECP Parallel Port Mode. In the forward direction (direction is 0) bytes placed into the
ecpDFifo and bytes written to the ecpAFifo are placed in a single FIFO and transmitted
automatically to the peripheral using ECP Protocol. In the reverse direction (direction is 1)
bytes are moved from the ECP parallel port and packed into bytes in the ecpDFifo. All
drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
100:
Selects EPP Mode: In this mode, EPP is selected if the EPP supported option is selected in
configuration register L3-CRF0. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
101:
Reserved
110:
Test Mode. In this mode the FIFO may be written and read, but the data will not be
transmitted on the parallel port. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
111:
Configuration Mode. In this mode the confgA, confgB registers are accessible at 0x400 and
0x401. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
Table 43B Table 43C
IRQ SELECTED
CONFIG REG B
BITS 5:3
DMA SELECTED
CONFIG REG B
BITS 2:0
15
110
3
011
14
101
2
010
11
100
1
001
10
011
All Others
000
9
010
7
001
5
111
All Others
000
102
OPERATION

Mode Switching/Software Control

Software will execute P1284 negotiation and all
operation prior to a data transfer phase under
programmed I/O control (mode 000 or 001).
Hardware provides an automatic control line
handshake, moving data between the FIFO and
the ECP port only in the data transfer phase
(modes 011 or 010).

Setting the mode to 011 or 010 will cause the
hardware to initiate data transfer.

If the port is in mode 000 or 001 it may switch to
any other mode. If the port is not in mode 000
or 001 it can only be switched into mode 000 or
001. The direction can only be changed in
mode 001.

Once in an extended forward mode the software
should wait for the FIFO to be empty before
switching back to mode 000 or 001. In this case
all control signals will be deasserted before the
mode switch. In an ecp reverse mode the
software waits for all the data to be read from
the FIFO before changing back to mode 000 or
001. Since the automatic hardware ecp
reverse handshake only cares about the state of
the FIFO it may have acquired extra data which
will be discarded. It may in fact be in the middle
of a transfer when the mode is changed back to
000 or 001. In this case the port will deassert
nAutoFd independent of the state of the transfer.
The design shall not cause glitches on the
handshake signals if the software meets the
constraints above.

ECP Operation

Prior to ECP operation the Host must negotiate
on the parallel port to determine if the peripheral
supports the ECP protocol. This is a
somewhat complex negotiation carried out
under program control in mode 000.
After negotiation, it is necessary to initialize
some of the port bits. The following are required:
·
Set Direction = 0, enabling the drivers.
·
Set strobe = 0, causing the nStrobe signal
to default to the deasserted state.
·
Set autoFd = 0, causing the nAutoFd
signal to default to the deasserted state.
·
Set mode = 011 (ECP Mode)
ECP address/RLE bytes or data bytes may be
sent automatically by writing the ecpAFifo or
ecpDFifo respectively.
Note that all FIFO data transfers are byte wide
and byte aligned. Address/RLE transfers are
byte-wide and only allowed in the forward
direction.
The host may switch directions by first switching
to mode = 001, negotiating for the forward or
reverse channel, setting direction to 1 or 0, then
setting mode = 011. When direction is 1 the
hardware shall handshake for each ECP read
data byte and attempt to fill the FIFO. Bytes
may then be read from the ecpDFifo as long as
it is not empty.
ECP transfers may also be accomplished (albeit
slowly) by handshaking individual bytes under
program control in mode = 001, or 000.
Termination from ECP Mode
Termination from ECP Mode is similar to the
termination from Nibble/Byte Modes. The host is
permitted to terminate from ECP Mode only in
specific well-defined states. The termination can
only be executed while the bus is in the forward
direction. To terminate while the channel is in
the reverse direction, it must first be transitioned
into the forward direction.
103
Command/Data
ECP Mode supports two advanced features to
improve the effectiveness of the protocol for
some applications. The features are
implemented by allowing the transfer of normal
8 bit data or 8 bit commands.
When in the forward direction, normal data is
transferred when HostAck is high and an 8 bit
command is transferred when HostAck is low.
The most significant bit of the command
indicates whether it is a run-length count (for
compression) or a channel address.
When in the reverse direction, normal data is
transferred when PeriphAck is high and an 8 bit
command is transferred when PeriphAck is low.
The most significant bit of the command is
always zero. Reverse channel addresses are
seldom used and may not be supported in
hardware.
TABLE 44 -
Forward Channel Commands (HostAck Low)
Reverse Channel Commands (PeripAck Low)
D7
D[6:0]
0
Run-Length Count (0-127)
(mode 0011 0X00 only)
1
Channel Address (0-127)
Data Compression
The ECP port supports run length encoded
(RLE) decompression in hardware and can
transfer compressed data to a peripheral. Run
length encoded (RLE) compression in hardware
is not supported. To transfer compressed data
in ECP mode, the compression count is written
to the ecpAFifo and the data byte is written to
the ecpDFifo.
Compression is accomplished by counting
identical bytes and transmitting an RLE byte
that indicates how many times the next byte is
to be repeated. Decompression simply
intercepts the RLE byte and repeats the
following byte the specified number of times.
When a run-length count is received from a
peripheral, the subsequent data byte is
replicated the specified number of times. A
run-length count of zero specifies that only one
byte of data is represented by the next data
byte, whereas a run-length count of 127
indicates that the next byte should be expanded
to 128 bytes. To prevent data expansion,
however, run-length counts of zero should be
avoided.
Pin Definition
The drivers for nStrobe, nAutoFd, nInit and
nSelectIn are open-collector in mode 000 and
are push-pull in all other modes.
ISA Connections
The interface can never stall causing the host to
hang. The width of data transfers is strictly
controlled on an I/O address basis per this
specification. All FIFO-DMA transfers are byte
wide, byte aligned and end on a byte boundary.
(The PWord value can be obtained by reading
Configuration Register A, cnfgA, described in
the next section). Single byte wide transfers
are always possible with standard or PS/2 mode
using program control of the control signals.
Interrupts
The interrupts are enabled by serviceIntr in the
ecr register.
serviceIntr = 1 Disables the DMA and all of the
service interrupts.
serviceIntr = 0 Enables the selected interrupt
condition. If the interrupting
condition is valid, then the
interrupt is generated
immediately when this bit is
changed from a 1 to a 0. This
can occur during Programmed
I/O if the number of bytes
removed or added from/to the
104
FIFO does not cross the
threshold.
The interrupt generated is ISA friendly in that it
must pulse the interrupt line low, allowing for
interrupt sharing. After a brief pulse low
following the interrupt event, the interrupt line is
tri-stated so that other interrupts may assert.
An interrupt is generated when:
1. For DMA transfers: When serviceIntr is 0,
dmaEn is 1 and the DMA TC is received.
2. For Programmed I/O:
a.
When serviceIntr is 0, dmaEn is 0,
direction is 0 and there are
writeIntrThreshold or more free bytes in
the FIFO. Also, an interrupt is
generated when serviceIntr is cleared
to 0 whenever there are
writeIntrThreshold or more free bytes in
the FIFO.
b.(1) When serviceIntr is 0, dmaEn is 0,
direction is 1 and there are
readIntrThreshold or more bytes in the
FIFO. Also, an interrupt is generated
when serviceIntr is cleared to 0
whenever there are readIntrThreshold
or more bytes in the FIFO.
3. When nErrIntrEn is 0 and nFault transitions
from high to low or when nErrIntrEn is set
from 1 to 0 and nFault is asserted.
4. When ackIntEn is 1 and the nAck signal
transitions from a low to a high.
FIFO Operation
The FIFO threshold is set in the chip
configuration registers. All data transfers to or
from the parallel port can proceed in DMA or
Programmed I/O (non-DMA) mode as indicated
by the selected mode. The FIFO is used by
selecting the Parallel Port FIFO mode or ECP
Parallel Port Mode. (FIFO test mode will be
addressed separately.) After a reset, the FIFO
is disabled. Each data byte is transferred by a
Programmed I/O cycle or PDRQ depending on
the selection of DMA or Programmed I/O mode.
The following paragraphs detail the operation of
the FIFO flow control. In these descriptions,
<threshold> ranges from 1 to 16. The
parameter FIFOTHR, which the user programs,
is one less and ranges from 0 to 15.
A low threshold value (i.e. 2) results in longer
periods of time between service requests, but
requires faster servicing of the request for both
read and write cases. The host must be very
responsive to the service request. This is the
desired case for use with a "fast" system. A
high value of threshold (i.e. 12) is used with a
"sluggish" system by affording a long latency
period after a service request, but results in
more frequent service requests.
DMA TRANSFERS
DMA transfers are always to or from the
ecpDFifo, tFifo or CFifo. DMA utilizes the
standard PC DMA services. To use the DMA
transfers, the host first sets up the direction and
state as in the programmed I/O case. Then it
programs the DMA controller in the host with the
desired count and memory address. Lastly it
sets dmaEn to 1 and serviceIntr to 0. The ECP
requests DMA transfers from the host by
activating the PDRQ pin. The DMA will empty
or fill the FIFO using the appropriate direction
and mode. When the terminal count in the DMA
controller is reached, an interrupt is generated
and serviceIntr is asserted, disabling DMA. In
order to prevent possible blocking of refresh
requests dReq shall not be asserted for more
than 32 DMA cycles in a row. The FIFO is
enabled directly by asserting nPDACK and
addresses need not be valid. PINTR is
generated when a TC is received. PDRQ must
not be asserted for more than 32 DMA cycles in
a row. After the 32nd cycle, PDRQ must be
kept unasserted until nPDACK is deasserted for
a minimum of 350nsec. (Note: The only way to
properly terminate DMA transfers is with a TC.)
105
DMA may be disabled in the middle of a transfer
by first disabling the host DMA controller. Then
setting serviceIntr to 1, followed by setting
dmaEn to 0, and waiting for the FIFO to become
empty or full. Restarting the DMA is
accomplished by enabling DMA in the host,
setting dmaEn to 1, followed by setting
serviceIntr to 0.
DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to the
Host
(Note: In the reverse mode, the peripheral may
not continue to fill the FIFO if it runs out of data
to transfer, even if the chip continues to request
more data from the peripheral.)
The ECP activates the PDRQ pin whenever
there is data in the FIFO. The DMA controller
must respond to the request by reading data
from the FIFO. The ECP will deactivate the
PDRQ pin when the FIFO becomes empty or
when the TC becomes true (qualified by
nPDACK), indicating that no more data is
required. PDRQ goes inactive after nPDACK
goes active for the last byte of a data transfer
(or on the active edge of nIOR, on the last byte,
if no edge is present on nPDACK). If PDRQ
goes inactive due to the FIFO going empty, then
PDRQ is active again as soon as there is one
byte in the FIFO. If PDRQ goes inactive due to
the TC, then PDRQ is active again when there is
one byte in the FIFO, and serviceIntr has been
re-enabled. (Note: A data underrun may occur if
PDRQ is not removed in time to prevent an
unwanted cycle).
Programmed I/O Mode or Non-DMA Mode
The ECP or parallel port FIFOs may also be
operated using interrupt driven programmed I/O.
Software can determine the writeIntrThreshold,
readIntrThreshold, and FIFO depth by accessing
the FIFO in Test Mode.
Programmed I/O transfers are to the ecpDFifo
at 400H and ecpAFifo at 000H or from the
ecpDFifo located at 400H, or to/from the tFifo at
400H. To use the programmed I/O transfers,
the host first sets up the direction and state, sets
dmaEn to 0 and serviceIntr to 0.
The ECP requests programmed I/O transfers
from the host by activating the PINTR pin. The
programmed I/O will empty or fill the FIFO using
the appropriate direction and mode.
Note: A threshold of 16 is equivalent to a
threshold of 15. These two cases are treated
the same.
Programmed I/O - Transfers from the FIFO to
the Host
In the reverse direction an interrupt occurs when
serviceIntr is 0 and readIntrThreshold bytes are
available in the FIFO. If at this time the FIFO is
full it can be emptied completely in a single
burst, otherwise readIntrThreshold bytes may be
read from the FIFO in a single burst.
readIntrThreshold =(16-<threshold>) data bytes
in FIFO
An interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is 0
and the number of bytes in the FIFO is greater
than or equal to (16-<threshold>). (If the
threshold = 12, then the interrupt is set
whenever there are 4-16 bytes in the FIFO). The
PINT pin can be used for interrupt-driven
systems. The host must respond to the request
by reading data from the FIFO. This process is
repeated until the last byte is transferred out of
the FIFO. If at this time the FIFO is full, it can
be completely emptied in a single burst,
otherwise a minimum of (16-<threshold>) bytes
may be read from the FIFO in a single burst.
106
Programmed I/O - Transfers from the Host to
the FIFO
In the forward direction an interrupt occurs when
serviceIntr is 0 and there are writeIntrThreshold
or more bytes free in the FIFO. At this time if
the FIFO is empty it can be filled with a single
burst before the empty bit needs to be re-read.
Otherwise it may be filled with
writeIntrThreshold bytes.
writeIntrThreshold =
(16-<threshold>) free
bytes in FIFO
An interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is 0
and the number of bytes in the FIFO is less than
or equal to <threshold>. (If the threshold = 12,
then the interrupt is set whenever there are 12 or
less bytes of data in the FIFO.) The PINT pin
can be used for interrupt-driven systems. The
host must respond to the request by writing data
to the FIFO. If at this time the FIFO is empty, it
can be completely filled in a single burst,
otherwise a minimum of (16-<threshold>) bytes
may be written to the FIFO in a single burst.
This process is repeated until the last byte is
transferred into the FIFO.
107
PARALLEL PORT FLOPPY DISK CONTROLLER
The Floppy Disk Control signals are available
optionally on the parallel port pins. When this
mode is selected, the parallel port is not
available. There are two modes of operation,
PPFD1 and PPFD2. These modes can be
selected in the Parallel Port Mode Register, as
defined in the Parallel Port Mode Register,
Logical Device 3, at 0xF1. PPFD1 has only
drive 1 on the parallel port pins; PPFD2 has
drive 0 and 1 on the parallel port pins.
When the PPFDC is selected the following pins
are set as follows:
1.
nPDACK: high-Z
2.
PDRQ: not ECP = high-Z, ECP & dmaEn =
0, ECP & not dmaEn = high-Z
3.
PINTR: not active, this is hi-Z or Low
depending on settings.
Note: nPDACK, PDRQ and PINTR refer to the
nDACK, DRQ and IRQ chosen for the parallel
port.
The following parallel port pins are read as
follows by a read of the parallel port register:
1.
Data Register (read) = last Data Register
(write)
2. Control Register read as "cable not
connected" STROBE, AUTOFD and SLC =
0 and nINIT =1
3.
Status Register reads: nBUSY = 0, PE = 0,
SLCT = 0, nACK = 1, nERR = 1
The following FDC pins are all in the high
impedence state when the PPFDC is actually
selected by the drive select register:
1.
nWDATA, DENSEL, nHDSEL, nWGATE,
nDIR, nSTEP, nDS1, nDS0, nMTR0,
nMTR1.
2.
If PPFDx is selected, then the parallel port
can not be used as a parallel port until
"Normal" mode is selected.
The FDC signals are muxed onto the Parallel
Port pins as shown in Table 42.
For ACPI compliance the FDD pins that are
multiplexed onto the Parallel Port function
independently of the state of the Parallel Port
controller. For example, if the FDC is enabled
onto the Parallel Port the multiplexed FDD
interface functions normally regardless of the
Parallel Port Power control, CR22.3. Table 41
illustrates this functionality.
TABLE 45 - PARALLEL PORT FDD CONTROL
PARALLEL
PORT POWER
PARALLEL PORT FDC
CONTROL
PARALLEL PORT
FDC STATE
PARALLEL PORT
STATE
CR22.3
LD3:CRF1.1
LD3:CRF1.0
1
0
0
OFF
ON
0
0
0
OFF
OFF
X
1
X
ON
OFF
X
1
(NOTE
1
)
NOTE
1
: The Parallel Port Control register reads as "Cable Not Connected" when the Parallel Port
FDC is enabled; i.e., STROBE = AUTOFD = SLC = 0 and nINIT = 1.
108
TABLE 46 - FDC PARALLEL PORT PINS
SPP MODE
PIN DIRECTION
FDC MODE
PIN DIRECTION
nSTROBE
I/O
(nDS0)
I/(O) Note1
PD0
I/O
nINDEX
I
PD1
I/O
nTRK0
I
PD2
I/O
nWP
I
PD3
I/O
nRDATA
I
PD4
I/O
nDSKCHG
I
PD5
I/O
-
-
PD6
I/O
(nMTR0)
I/(O) Note1
PD7
I/O
-
-
nACK
I
nDS1
O
BUSY
I
nMTR1
O
PE
I
nWDATA
O
SLCT
I
nWGATE
O
nALF
I/O
DRVDEN0
O
nERROR
I
nHDSEL
O
nINIT
I/O
nDIR
O
nSLCTIN
I/O
nSTEP
O
Note 1: These pins are outputs in mode PPFD2, inputs in mode PPFD1.
Refer to Force Write Protect in the Floppy Disk Controller section for information on the Floppy disk
Controller Force Write Protect function.
109
POWER MANAGEMENT
Power management capabilities are provided for
the following logical devices: floppy disk, UART
1, UART 2 and the parallel port. For each
logical device, two types of power management
are provided; direct powerdown and auto
powerdown.
FDC POWER MANAGEMENT
Direct power management is controlled by
CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-
B0. When set, this bit allows FDC to enter
powerdown when all of the following conditions
have been met:
1.
The motor enable pins of register 3F2H are
inactive (zero).
2.
The part must be idle; MSR=80H and INT =
0 (INT may be high even if MSR = 80H due
to polling interrupts).
3.
The head unload timer must have expired.
4.
The Auto powerdown timer (10msec) must
have timed out.
An internal timer is initiated as soon as the auto
powerdown command is enabled. The part is
then powered down when all the conditions are
met.
Disabling the auto powerdown mode cancels the
timer and holds the FDC block out of auto
powerdown.
DSR From Powerdown
If DSR powerdown is used when the part is in
auto powerdown, the DSR powerdown will
override the auto powerdown. However, when
the part is awakened from DSR powerdown, the
auto powerdown will once again become
effective.
Wake Up From Auto Powerdown
If the part enters the powerdown state through
the auto powerdown mode, then the part can be
awakened by reset or by appropriate access to
certain registers.
If a hardware or software reset is used then the
part will go through the normal reset sequence.
If the access is through the selected registers,
then the FDC resumes operation as though it
was never in powerdown. Besides activating the
RESET pin or one of the software reset bits in
the DOR or DSR, the following register
accesses will wake up the part:
1.
Enabling any one of the motor enable bits
in the DOR register (reading the DOR does
not awaken the part).
2.
A read from the MSR register.
3.
A read or write to the Data register.
Once awake, the FDC will reinitiate the auto
powerdown timer for 10 ms. The part will
powerdown again when all the powerdown
conditions are satisfied.
Register Behavior
Table 44 illustrates the AT and PS/2 (including
Model 30) configuration registers available and
the type of access permitted. In order to
maintain software transparency, access to all
the registers must be maintained. As Table 44
shows, two sets of registers are distinguished
based on whether their access results in the part
remaining in powerdown state or exiting it.
110
Access to all other registers is possible without
awakening the part. These registers can be
accessed during powerdown without changing
the status of the part. A read from these
registers will reflect the true status as shown in
the register description in the FDC description. A
write to the part will result in the part retaining
the data and subsequently reflecting it when the
part awakens. Accessing the part during
powerdown may cause an increase in the power
consumption by the part. The part will revert
back to its low power mode when the access
has been completed.
Pin Behavior
This chip is specifically designed for systems in
which power conservation is a primary concern.
This makes the behavior of the pins during
powerdown very important.
The pins can be divided into two major
categories: system interface and floppy disk
drive interface. The floppy disk drive pins are
disabled so that no power will be drawn through
the part as a result of any voltage applied to the
pin within the part's power supply range. Most
of the system interface pins are left active to
monitor system accesses that may wake up the
part.
System Interface Pins
Table 48 gives the state of the system interface
pins in the powerdown state. Pins unaffected by
the powerdown are labeled "Unchanged". Input
pins are "Disabled" to prevent them from
causing currents internal to the chip when they
have indeterminate input values.
111
TABLE 47 - PC/AT AND PS/2 AVAILABLE REGISTERS
AVAILABLE REGISTERS
BASE +
ADDRESS
PC-AT
PS/2 (MODEL 30)
ACCESS PERMITTED
Access to these registers DOES NOT wake up the part
00H
----
SRA
R
01H
----
SRB
R
02H
DOR (1)
DOR (1)
R/W
03H
---
---
---
04H
DSR (1)
DSR (1)
W
06H
---
---
---
07H
DIR
DIR
R
07H
CCR
CCR
W
Access to these registers wakes up the part
04H
MSR
MSR
R
05H
Data
Data
R/W
Note 1: Writing to the DOR or DSR does not wake up the part, however, writing any of the
motor enable bits or doing a software reset (via DOR or DSR reset bits) will wake up
the part.
TABLE 48 - STATE OF SYSTEM PINS IN AUTO POWERDOWN
SYSTEM PINS
STATE IN AUTO POWERDOWN
INPUT PINS
nIOR
Unchanged
nIOW
Unchanged
SA[0:9]
Unchanged
SD[0:7]
Unchanged
RESET_DRV
Unchanged
DACKx
Unchanged
TC
Unchanged
OUTPUT PINS
IRQx
Unchanged (low)
SD[0:7]
Unchanged
DRQx
Unchanged (low)
FDD Interface Pins
All pins in the FDD interface which can be
connected directly to the floppy disk drive itself
are either DISABLED or TRISTATED.
Pins used for local logic control or part
programming are unaffected. Table 46 depicts
the state of the floppy disk drive interface pins in
the powerdown state.
112
TABLE 49 - STATE OF FLOPPY DISK DRIVE INTERFACE PINS IN POWERDOWN
FDD PINS
STATE IN AUTO POWERDOWN
INPUT PINS
nRDATA
Input
nWPROT
Input
nTR0
Input
nINDEX
Input
nDSKCHG
Input
OUTPUT PINS
nMTR0
Tristated
nDS0
Tristated
nDIR
Active
nSTEP
Active
nWDATA
Tristated
nWGATE
Tristated
nHDSEL
Active
DRVDEN[0:1]
Active
113
UART POWER MANAGEMENT
Direct power management is controlled by
CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-
B4 and B5. When set, these bits allow the
following auto power management operations:
1.
The transmitter enters auto powerdown
when the transmit buffer and shift register
are empty.
2.
The receiver enters powerdown when the
following conditions are all met:
A.
Receive FIFO is empty
B.
The receiver is waiting for a start bit.
Note:
While in powerdown the Ring Indicator
interrupt is still valid and transitions
when the RI input changes.
Exit Auto Powerdown
The transmitter exits powerdown on a write to
the XMIT buffer. The receiver exits auto
powerdown when RXDx changes state.
PARALLEL PORT
Direct power management is controlled by
CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-
B3. When set, this bit allows the ECP or EPP
logical parallel port blocks to be placed into
powerdown when not being used.
The EPP logic is in powerdown under any of the
following conditions:
1.
EPP is not enabled in the configuration
registers.
2.
EPP is not selected through ecr while in
ECP mode.
The ECP logic is in powerdown under any of the
following conditions:
1.
ECP is not enabled in the configuration
registers.
2
SPP, PS/2 Parallel port or EPP mode is
selected through ecr while in ECP mode.
Exit Auto Powerdown
The parallel port logic can change powerdown
modes when the ECP mode is changed through
the ecr register or when the parallel port mode is
changed through the configuration registers.
V
BAT
Support
This chip requires a (TBD) MicroAmp battery
supply (V
BAT
) to provide battery backed up
registers. These registers retain the contents of
the general purpose registers and wake-up
event registers.
V
TR
Support
The FDC37B72x requires a 25 mA trickle
(standby) supply (V
TR
) to provide sleep current
for the programmable wake-up events in the
Soft Power Management logic, SCI, PME and
SMI interfaces when V
CC
is removed. If the
FDC37B72x is not intended to provide wake-up
capabilities on standby power, V
TR
can be
connected to V
CC
. V
TR
powers the IR interface,
the PME registers, the PME interface, the ACPI
registers, the SCI interface, the GPIO logic, the
GPIO configuration registers and other wakeup
related configuration registers. The V
TR
pin
generates a V
TR
Power-on-Reset signal to
initialize certain components. All wakeup event
registers and related logic are battery backed-up
to retain the configuration of the wakeup events
upon a power loss (i.e., V
CC
= 0 V and V
TR
= 0
V). These registers are reset on a V
BAT
POR.
The following section lists the pins that are
active under VTR power.
114
INTERNAL PWRGOOD
An internal PWRGOOD logical control is
included to minimize the effects of pin-state
uncertainty in the host interface as V
cc
cycles on
and off. When the internal PWRGOOD signal is
"1" (active), V
cc
is > 4V, and the FDC37B72x
host interface is active. When the internal
PWRGOOD signal is "0" (inactive), V
cc
is
4V,
and the FDC37B72x host interface is inactive;
that is, ISA bus reads and writes will not be
decoded.
The FDC37B72x device pins KDAT, MDAT,
IRRX, nRI1, nRI2, RXD1, RXD2, nRING,
Button_In and the GPIOs are part of the PME
interface and remain active as inputs for wakeup
when the internal PWRGOOD signal has gone
inactive, provided V
TR
is powered. In addition,
the nPME/SCI, GP53/IRQ11 (SCI pin),
nPowerOn and CLK32OUT pins remain active
as outputs when the internal PWRGOOD is
inactive and V
TR
is powered. The internal
PWRGOOD signal is also used to disable the IR
Half Duplex Timeout.
Note: If V
TR
is to be used for programmable
wake-up events when V
CC
is removed, V
TR
must
be at its full minimum potential at least 10
µ
s
before V
cc
begins a power-on cycle. When V
TR
and V
cc
are fully powered, the potential
difference between the two supplies must not
exceed 500mV.
32.768 kHz STANDBY CLOCK OUTPUT
The FDC37B72x provides a 32.768 kHz trickle
clock output pin. This output is active as long
as V
TR
is present.
OSCILLATOR
Crystal Oscillator input. A 32.768kHz crystal
connected externally on the XTAL1 and XTAL2
pins generates the 32.768kHz input clock.
Maximum clock frequency is 32.768kHz. This
oscillator is also used as an internal clock
source for functions within the FDC37B72x.
There is a bit in the Ring Filter Select Register
that can be used to select the load capacitance
of the crystal to ensure accurate time keeping.
This bit is defined as follows: Bit 6 -
XTAL_CAP. This bit is used to specify the
32kHz XTAL load capacitance (12pF vs. 6pF):
0=12pF (Default), 1=6pF.
115
SERIAL IRQ
The FDC37B72x supports serial interrupts to transmit interrupt information to the host system. The
serial interrupt scheme adheres to the Serial IRQ Specification for PCI Systems, Version 6.0.
Timing Diagrams For IRQSER Cycle
PCICLK = 33Mhz_IN pin
IRQSER = SIRQ pin
A) Start Frame timing with source sampled a low pulse on IRQ1
R
T
S
R
T
S
IRQSER
PCICLK
Host Controller
IRQ1
IRQ1
Drive Source
R
T
None
IRQ0 FRAME IRQ1 FRAME
S
R
T
IRQ2 FRAME
None
START
START FRAME
H
SL
or
H
1
H=Host Control
R=Recovery
SL=Slave Control
T=Turn-around
S=Sample
1) Start Frame pulse can be 4-8 clocks wide.
116
B) Stop Frame Timing with Host using 17 IRQSER sampling period
S
R
T
S
IRQSER
PCICLK
Host Controller
IRQ15
Driver
R
T
None
IRQ14
IRQ15
S
R
T
IOCHCK#
None
STOP
R
T
STOP FRAME
H
I
START
NEXT CYCLE
1
2
3
FRAME
FRAME
FRAME
H=Host Control
T=Turn-around
R=Recovery
S=Sample
I= Idle.
1)
Stop pulse is 2 clocks wide for Quiet mode, 3 clocks wide for Continuous mode.
2)
There may be none, one or more Idle states during the Stop Frame.
3)
The next IRQSER cycle's Start Frame pulse may or may not start immediately
after the turn-around clock of the Stop Frame.
IRQSER Cycle Control
There are two modes of operation for the
IRQSER Start Frame.
1) Quiet (Active) Mode: Any device may initiate
a Start Frame by driving the IRQSER low for
one clock, while the IRQSER is Idle. After
driving low for one clock the IRQSER must
immediately be tri-stated without at any time
driving high. A Start Frame may not be initiated
while the IRQSER is Active. The IRQSER is
Idle between Stop and Start Frames. The
IRQSER is Active between Start and Stop
Frames. This mode of operation allows the
IRQSER to be Idle when there are no IRQ/Data
transitions which should be most of the time.
Once a Start Frame has been initiated the Host
Controller will take over driving the IRQSER low
in the next clock and will continue driving the
IRQSER low for a programmable period of three
to seven clocks.
This makes a total low pulse width of four to
eight clocks. Finally, the Host Controller will
drive the IRQSER back high for one clock, then
tri-state.
Any IRQSER Device (i.e., The FDC37B72x)
which detects any transition on an IRQ/Data line
for which it is responsible must initiate a Start
Frame in order to update the Host Controller
unless the IRQSER is already in an IRQSER
Cycle and the IRQ/Data transition can be
delivered in that IRQSER Cycle.
2) Continuous (Idle) Mode: Only the Host
controller can initiate a Start Frame to update
IRQ/Data line information. All other IRQSER
agents become passive and may not initiate a
Start Frame. IRQSER will be driven low for four
to eight clocks by Host Controller. This mode
has two functions. It can be used to stop or idle
the IRQSER or the Host Controller can operate
IRQSER in a continuous mode by initiating a
Start Frame at the end of every Stop Frame.
117
An IRQSER mode transition can only occur
during the Stop Frame. Upon reset, IRQSER
bus is defaulted to Continuous mode,
therefore only the Host controller can initiate
the first Start Frame. Slaves must
continuously sample the Stop Frames pulse
width to determine the next IRQSER Cycle's
mode.
IRQSER Data Frame
Once a Start Frame has been initiated, the
FDC37B72x will watch for the rising edge of the
Start Pulse and start counting IRQ/Data Frames
from there. Each IRQ/Data Frame is three
clocks: Sample phase, Recovery phase, and
Turn-around phase. During the Sample phase
the FDC37B72x must drive the IRQSER (SIRQ
pin) low, if and only if, its last detected IRQ/Data
value was low. If its detected IRQ/Data value is
high, IRQSER must be left tri-stated. During the
Recovery phase the FDC37B72x must drive the
SERIRQ high, if and only if, it had driven the
IRQSER low during the previous Sample Phase.
During the Turn-around Phase the FDC37B72x
must tri-state the SERIRQ. The FDC37B72x will
drive the IRQSER line low at the appropriate
sample point if its associated IRQ/Data line is
low, regardless of which device initiated the
Start Frame.
The Sample Phase for each IRQ/Data follows
the low to high transition of the Start Frame
pulse by a number of clocks equal to the
IRQ/Data Frame times three, minus one. (e.g.
The IRQ5 Sample clock is the sixth IRQ/Data
Frame, (6 x 3) - 1 = 17th clock after the rising
edge of the Start Pulse).
IRQSER Sampling Periods
IRQSER PERIOD
SIGNAL SAMPLED
# OF CLOCKS PAST START
1
Not Used
2
2
IRQ1
5
3
nSMI/IRQ2
8
4
IRQ3
11
5
IRQ4
14
6
IRQ5
17
7
IRQ6
20
8
IRQ7
23
9
IRQ8
26
10
IRQ9
29
11
IRQ10
32
12
IRQ11
35
13
IRQ12
38
14
IRQ13
41
15
IRQ14
44
16
IRQ15
47
118
The SIRQ data frame will now support IRQ2
from a logical device, previously IRQSER Period
3 was reserved for use by the System
Management Interrupt (nSMI). When using
Period 3 for IRQ2 the user should mask off the
SMI via the SMI Enable Register. Likewise,
when using Period 3 for nSMI the user should
not configure any logical devices as using IRQ2.
IRQSER Period 14 is used to transfer IRQ13.
Logical devices 0 (FDC), 3 (Par Port), 4 (Ser
Port 1), 5 (Ser Port 2), and 7 (KBD) shall have
IRQ13 as a choice for their primary interrupt.
The SMI is enabled onto the SMI frame of the
Serial IRQ via bit 6 of SMI Enable Register 2
and onto the SMI pin via bit 7 of the SMI Enable
Register 2.
Note: When Serial IRQs are used, nIRQ8,
nSCI and nSMI may be output on one of their
respective pin options. See the IRQ MUX
Configuration Register.
Stop Cycle Control
Once all IRQ/Data Frames have completed the
Host Controller will terminate IRQSER activity
by initiating a Stop Frame. Only the Host
Controller can initiate the Stop Frame. A Stop
Frame is indicated when the IRQSER is low for
two or three clocks. If the Stop Frame's low
time is two clocks then the next IRQSER Cycle's
sampled mode is the Quiet mode; and any
IRQSER device may initiate a Start Frame in
the second clock or more after the rising edge of
the Stop Frame's pulse. If the Stop Frame's low
time is three clocks then the next IRQSER
Cycle's sampled mode is the Continuos mode;
and only the Host Controller may initiate a Start
Frame in the second clock or more after the
rising edge of the Stop Frame's pulse.
Latency
Latency for IRQ/Data updates over the IRQSER
bus in bridge-less systems with the minimum
IRQ/Data Frames of seventeen, will range up to
96 clocks (3.84
µ
S with a 25MHz PCI Bus or
2.88uS with a 33MHz PCI Bus). If one or more
PCI to PCI Bridge is added to a system, the
latency for IRQ/Data updates from the
secondary or tertiary buses will be a few clocks
longer for synchronous buses, and
approximately double for asynchronous buses.
EOI/ISR Read Latency
Any serialized IRQ scheme has a potential
implementation issue related to IRQ latency.
IRQ latency could cause an EOI or ISR Read to
precede an IRQ transition that it should have
followed. This could cause a system fault. The
host interrupt controller is responsible for
ensuring that these latency issues are mitigated.
The recommended solution is to delay EOIs and
ISR Reads to the interrupt controller by the
same amount as the IRQSER Cycle latency in
order to ensure that these events do not occur
out of order.
AC/DC Specification Issue
All IRQSER agents must drive / sample
IRQSER synchronously related to the rising
edge of PCI bus clock. IRQSER (SIRQ) pin uses
the electrical specification of PCI bus. Electrical
parameters will follow PCI spec. section 4,
sustained tri-state.
Reset and Initialization
The IRQSER bus uses RESET_DRV as its reset
signal. The IRQSER pin is tri-stated by all
agents while RESET_DRV is active. With reset,
IRQSER Slaves are put into the (continuous)
IDLE mode. The Host Controller is responsible
for starting the initial IRQSER Cycle to collect
system's IRQ/Data default values. The system
then follows with the Continuous/Quiet mode
protocol (Stop Frame pulse width) for
119
subsequent IRQSER Cycles. It is Host
Controller's responsibility to provide the default
values to 8259's and other system logic before
the first IRQSER Cycle is performed. For
IRQSER system suspend, insertion, or removal
application, the Host controller should be
programmed into Continuous (IDLE) mode first.
This is to guarantee IRQSER bus is in IDLE
state before the system configuration changes.
120
BIOS BUFFER
The chip contains one 245 type buffer that can
be used for a BIOS Buffer. If the BIOS buffer is
not used, then nROMCS must be tied high or
pulled up to Vcc with a resistor so as not to
interfere with the boot ROM. This function
allows data transmission from the RD bus to the
SD bus or from the SD bus to the RD bus. The
direction of the transfer is controlled by
nROMOE. The enable input, nROMCS, can be
used to disable the transfer and isolate the
buses.
nROMCS
nROMOE
DESCRIPTION
L
L
RD[0:7] data to SD[0:7] bus
L
H
SD[0:7] data to RD[0:7]
H
X
Isolation
RD Bus Functionality
The following cases described below illustrate
the use of the RD Bus.
Case 1: nROMCS and nROMOE as original
function. The RD bus can be used as the RD
bus or one or more RD pins can be
programmed as alternate function. These
alternate functions behave as follows: if in RD to
SD mode, any value on RDx will appear on SDx;
if in SD to RD mode, SDx will not appear on
RDx, RDx gets the alternate function value.
Note: In this case, nROMCS=0, nROMOE=1.
Case 2: nROMOE as GPIO function. (nROMOE
internally tied to ground). In this case, the RD
bus is a unidirectional bus (read only) controlled
by nROMCS. If nROMCS = 0, the values on
RD0-7 appear on SD0-7. If nROMCS = 1, the
RD bus is disabled, and nothing appears on the
SD bus. Note: any RD bus pin can be
programmed as an alternate function, however,
if nROMCS=0, then anything on the RD bus will
appear on the SD bus.
Case 3: nROMCS as GPIO function. (nROMCS
internally tied to VDD.) The RD bus floats -
cannot use as a bus. Any pin can be
programmed as an alternate function.
Case 4: nROMCS and nROMOE as GPIO
function. Same as Case 3.
Case 5: Parallel IRQ enabled; RD Bus pins,
nROMOE, nROMCS are used as IRQ pins.
121
GENERAL PURPOSE I/O
The FDC37B72x provides a set of flexible
Input/Output control functions to the system
designer through the 20 dedicated
independently programmable General Purpose
I/O pins (GPIO). The GPIO pins can perform
simple I/O or can be individually configured to
provide predefined alternate functions. VBAT
Power-On-Reset configures all GPIO pins as
non-inverting inputs.
DESCRIPTION
Each GPIO port requires a 1-bit data register
and an 8-bit configuration control register. The
data register for each GPIO port is represented
as a bit in one of three 8-bit GPIO DATA
Registers, GP1, GP5, and GP6. All of the GPIO
registers are located in Logical Device Block No.
8 in the FDC37B72x device configuration space.
The GPIO DATA Registers are also optionally
available at different addresses when the
FDC37B72x is in the Run state (see the Run
State GPIO Register Access section below).
The GPIO ports with their alternate functions
and configuration state register addresses are
listed in TABLE 50. Note: four bits 1, 5-7 of
GP5 are not implemented.
TABLE 50 - GENERAL PURPOSE I/O PORT ASSIGNMENTS
PIN NO.
QFP
DEFAULT
FUNCTION
ALT.
FUNC. 1
ALT.
FUNC. 2
ALT.
FUNC. 3
DATA
REGISTER
5
(HEX)
DATA
REGISTER
BIT NO.
CONFIG.
REGISTER
5
(HEX)
77
GPIO
nSMI
-
-
GP1
0
CRE0
78
GPIO
nRING
EETI
1
-
(CRF6)
1
CRE1
79
GPIO
WDT
P17/P12
4
EETI
1
2
CRE2
80
GPIO
LED
-
-
3
CRE3
81
GPIO
IRRX2
-
-
4
CRE4
82
GPIO
IRTX2
-
-
5
CRE5
4
GPIO
nMTR1
-
-
6
CRE6
6
GPIO
nDS1
-
-
7
CRE7
39
PCI_CLK
IRQ14
GPIO
-
GP5
0
CRC8
2
GPIO
DRVDEN1
IRQ8
nSMI
(CRF9)
2
CRCA
91
nROMCS
2
IRQ11
GPIO
EETI
1
3
CRCB
92
nROMOE
2
IRQ12
GPIO
EETI
1
4
CRCC
83
RD0
2,3
IRQ1
GPIO
nSMI
GP6
0
CRD0
84
RD1
2,3
IRQ3
GPIO
LED
(CRFA)
1
CRD1
85
RD2
2,3
IRQ4
GPIO
nRING
2
CRD2
86
RD3
2,3
IRQ5
GPIO
WDT
3
CRD3
87
RD4
2,3
IRQ6
GPIO
P17/P12
4
4
CRD4
88
RD5
2,3
IRQ7
GPIO
-
5
CRD5
89
RD6
2,3
IRQ8
GPIO
-
6
CRD6
90
RD7
2,3
IRQ10
GPIO
-
7
CRD7
Note 1:
Refer to the section on Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Inputs.
Note 2:
At power-up, RD0-7, nROMCS and nROMOE function as the XD Bus. To use RD0-7 for
alternate functions, nROMCS must stay high until those pins are finished being
programmed.
Note 3:
These pins cannot be programmed as open drain pins in their original function.
122
Note 4:
The function of P17 or P12 is selected via the P17/P12 select bit in the Ring Filter Select
Register in Logical Device 8 at 0xC6.
Note 5:
The GPIO Data and Configuration Registers are located in Logical Device Block Number
8.
RUN STATE GPIO DATA REGISTER
ACCESS
The GPIO data registers as well as the
Watchdog Timer Control, and the Soft Power
Enable and Status registers can be accessed by
the host when the chip is in the run state if
CR03 Bit[7] = 1. The host uses an Index and
Data port to access these registers (TABLE 51).
The Index and Data port power-on default
addresses are 0xEA and 0xEB respectively. In
the configuration state the Index port address
may be re-programmed to 0xE0, 0xE2, 0xE4 or
0xEA; the Data port address is automatically set
to the Index port address + 1. Upon exiting the
configuration state the new Index and Data port
addresses are used to access the GPIO data,
Soft Power Status and Enable, and the
Watchdog Timer Control registers.
For example, to access the GP1 data register
when in the run state, the host should perform
an I/O Write of 0x01 to the Index port address
(0xEx) to select GP1 and then read or write the
Data port (at Index+1) to access the GP1
register. Generally, to access any GPIO data
register GPx the host should perform an I/O
Write of 0x0x to the Index port address and then
access GPx through the Data port. The Soft
Power and Watchdog Timer Control registers
are accessed similarly.
TABLE 51 - INDEX AND DATA PORTS
PORT
NAME
PORT
ADDRESS
RUN STATE ACCESS
Index
0xE0, E2, E4, EA
0x01-0x0F
Data
Index address + 1
Access to GP1, Watchdog Timer
Control, GP5, GP6, and the Soft
Power Status and Enable
registers (see TABLE 52).
TABLE 52 - RUN STATE ACCESSABLE CONFIGURATION REGISTERS
RUN STATE REGISTER
ADDRESS (INDEX)
REGISTER (CONFIGURATION STATE ADDRESSING
1
)
0x01
GP1 (L8 - CRF6)
0x03
Watchdog Timer Control (L8 - CRF4)
0x05
GP5 (L8 - CRF9)
0x06
GP6 (L8 - CRFA)
0x08
Soft Power Enable Register 1 (L8-CRB0)
0x09
Soft Power Enable Register 2 (L8-CRB1)
0x0A
Soft Power Status Register 1 (L8-CRB2)
0x0B
Soft Power Status Register 2 (L8-CRB3)
Note 1: These registers can also be accessed through the configuration registers L8 - CRxx, as
shown, when the FDC37B72x is in the configuration state.
GPIO CONFIGURATION
Each GPIO port has an 8-bit configuration
register that controls the behavior of the pin.
123
The GPIO configuration registers are only
accessible when the FDC37B72x is in the
Configuration state; more information can be
found in the Configuration section of this
specification.
Each GPIO port may be configured as either an
input or an output. If the pin is configured as an
output, it can be programmed as open-drain or
push-pull. Inputs and outputs can be configured
as non-inverting or inverting and can be
programmed to generate an interrupt. GPIO
ports can also be configured as a pre-defined
alternate function. Bit[0] of each GPIO
Configuration Register determines the port
direction, bit[1] determines the signal polarity,
bits[4:3] select the port function, bit[5] enables
the interrupt, and bit[7] determines the output
driver type select. The GPIO configuration
register Output Type select bit[7] applies to
GPIO functions, the Watchdog Timer WDT, the
LED and the nSMI Alternate functions. The
basic GPIO configuration options are
summarized in TABLE 53.
For Alternate functions, the pin direction is set
and controlled internally, regardless of the state
of the GPIO Direction bit[0]. Also, selected
Alternate INPUT functions cannot be inverted,
regardless of the state of the GPIO polarity
bit[1], except for the EETI function.
The interrupt channel for the group Interrupts is
selected by the GP_INT[2:1] configuration
registers defined in the FDC37B72x
Configuration Register Section. The group
interrupts are the "ORed" function of the group
interrupt enabled GPIO ports and will represent
a standard ISA interrupt (edge high). GPIO
Group 1 and 2 Interrupts can generate SMI
events, wake-up events through the Soft Power
Management logic, and SCI/PME events. See
the ACPI, PME and SMI section for details.
When the group interrupt is enabled on a GPIO
input port, the interrupt circuitry contains a
selectable digital debounce filter so that
switches or push-buttons may be directly
connected to the chip. The debounce filters
reject signals with pulse widths
1ms and are
enabled per interrupt group in the GP_INT[2:1]
configuration registers.
The state of unconnected GPIO alternate input
functions is inactive. For example, if bits[4:3] in
LD8 -CRCB are not "00", i.e. nROMCS is not the
selected function for GP53, internally the state
of nROMCS is inactive, "1".
124
TABLE 53 - GPIO CONFIGURATION SUMMARY
SELECTED
FUNCTION
DIRECTION
BIT
POLARITY
BIT
GROUP INT.
ENABLE BIT
DESCRIPTION
B0
B1
B5
GPIO
0
0
0
Pin is a non-inverted output
with the Interrupt disabled.
0
0
1
Pin is a non-inverted output
with the Interrupt enabled.
0
1
0
Pin is an inverted output with
the Interrupt disabled.
0
1
1
Pin is a inverted output with
the Interrupt enabled.
1
0
0
Pin is a non-inverted input
with the Interrupt disabled.
1
0
1
Pin is a non-inverted input
with the Interrupt enabled.
1
1
0
Pin is an inverted input with
the Interrupt disabled.
1
1
1
Pin is a inverted input with the
Interrupt enabled.
ALT.
X
1
0
0
Non-inverted alternate
function with Interrupt
disabled.
0
1
Non-inverted alternate
function with Interrupt
enabled.
1
2
0
Alternate OUTPUT functions
are inverted, Alternate INPUT
functions are non-inverted;
Interrupts are disabled.
1
Alternate OUTPUT functions
are inverted, Alternate INPUT
functions are non-inverted;
Interrupts are enabled.
Note 1: For alternate function selects, the pin direction is set and controlled internally; i.e., regardless
of the state of the GPIO configuration register Direction bit.
Note 2: For alternate function selects, INPUT functions cannot be inverted, regardless of the state of
the GPIO polarity bit, except for the EETI function.
125
GPIO OPERATION
The operation of the GPIO ports is illustrated in
FIGURE 4
. Note:
FIGURE 4
is for illustration
purposes only and is not intended to suggest specific implementation details.
When a GPIO port is programmed as an input,
reading it through the GPIO data register
latches either the inverted or non-inverted logic
value present at the GPIO pin. Writing to a
GPIO port that is programmed as an input has
no effect (TABLE 54).
When a GPIO port is programmed as an output,
the logic value or the inverted logic value that
has been written into the GPIO data register is
output to the GPIO pin. Reading from a GPIO
port that is programmed as an output returns
the last value written to the data register (TABLE
54).
TABLE 54 - GPIO READ/WRITE BEHAVIOR
HOST OPERATION
GPIO INPUT PORT
GPIO OUTPUT PORT
READ
LATCHED VALUE OF GPIO
PIN
LAST WRITE TO GPIO DATA
REGISTER
WRITE
NO EFFECT
BIT PLACED IN GPIO DATA
REGISTER
GPIO
PIN
GPIO
Data Register
Bit-n
SD-bit
GPx_nIOR
GPIO
Configuration
Register bit-1
(Polarity)
GPIO
Configuration
Register bit-2 or 5
(GROUP INT. ENABLE)
GPIO
Configuration
Register bit-0
(Input/Output)
GP Group Interrupts (1 or 2)
0
1
1
0
D-TYPE
Transparent
GPx_nIOW
D
Q
Q
D
FIGURE 4 - GPIO FUNCTION ILLUSTRATION
126
WATCH DOG TIMER
The FDC37B72x contains a Watch Dog Timer
(WDT). The Watch Dog Time-out status bit may
be mapped to an interrupt through the
WDT_CFG Configuration Register. It can also
be brought out on the GP12 or GP63 pins by
programming the corresponding GPIO
configuration register.
The FDC37B72x's WDT has a programmable
time-out ranging from 1 to 255 minutes with one
minute resolution, or 1 to 255 seconds with 1
second resolution. The units of the WDT
timeout value are selected via bit[7] of the
WDT_TIMEOUT register (LD8:CRF1.7). The
WDT time-out value is set through the
WDT_VAL Configuration register. Setting the
WDT_VAL register to 0x00 disables the WDT
function (this is its power on default). Setting
the WDT_VAL to any other non-zero value will
cause the WDT to reload and begin counting
down from the value loaded. When the WDT
count value reaches zero the counter stops and
sets the Watchdog time-out status bit in the
WDT_CTRL Configuration Register. Note:
Regardless of the current state of the WDT, the
WDT time-out status bit can be directly set or
cleared by the Host CPU.
There are three system events which can reset
the WDT. These are a Keyboard Interrupt, a
Mouse Interrupt, or I/O reads/writes to address
0x201 (the internal or an external Joystick Port).
The effect on the WDT for each of these system
events may be individually enabled or disabled
through bits in the WDT_CFG configuration
register. When a system event is enabled
through the WDT_CFG register, the occurrence
of that event will cause the WDT to reload the
value stored in WDT_VAL and reset the WDT
time-out status bit if set. If all three system
events are disabled the WDT will inevitably time
out.
The Watch Dog Timer may be configured to
generate an interrupt on the rising edge of the
Time-out status bit. The WDT interrupt is
mapped to an interrupt channel through the
WDT_CFG Configuration Register. When
mapped to an interrupt the interrupt request pin
reflects the value of the WDT time-out status bit.
The host may force a Watch Dog time-out to
occur by writing a "1" to bit 2 of the WDT_CTRL
(Force WD Time-out) Configuration Register.
Writing a "1" to this bit forces the WDT count
value to zero and sets bit 0 of the WDT_CTRL
(Watch Dog Status). Bit 2 of the WDT_CTRL is
self-clearing.
LED
The FDC37B72x can directly drive an LED using
the alternate function of GP13 or GP61 (only
one may be used at at time). These pins are
active under VTR power so the LED may be
used in any system power state. The GPIO
used for the LED will initially default to an input;
the corresponding GPIO configuration register
must be programmed to configure the pin for the
LED function and as a push pull or an open
drain output. However, under VTR power the
LED must be configured as open drain, since
the pin cannot drive current under VTR power.
The polarity bit may be chosen as either non-
inverted or inverted (active high or active low).
The LED can be turned on and off or toggled at
a 1 Hertz rate with a 50 percent duty cycle.
When the GP13 or GP61 pin is configured as a
non-inverted, open drain output and the LED
function is chosen, the LED may be turned on
by writing `1' the GP1 register bit 3 or the GP6
register bit 1. Clearing these bits will then turn
the LED off. The LED may be toggled as
described below. Note that the GPIO can
control the LED in its default GPIO function, but
it may only toggle if the LED function is chosen.
127
Setting bit 1 of the WDT_CTRL configuration
register will cause the Power LED output driver
to toggle at 1 Hertz with a 50 percent duty cycle.
When this bit is cleared the Power LED output
will drive continuously unless it has been
configured to toggle on Watch Dog time-out
conditions. Setting bit 3 of the WDT_CFG
configuration register will cause the Power LED
output driver to toggle at 1 Hertz with a 50
percent duty cycle whenever the WDT time-out
status bit is set. The truth table below clarifies
the conditions for which the Power LED will
toggle.
TABLE 55 - LED TOGGLE
WDT_CTRL BIT[1]
LED TOGGLE
WDT_CFG BIT[3]
POWER LED
TOGGLE ON WDT
WDT_CTRL BIT[0]
WDT T/O STATUS BIT
LED STATE
1
X
X
Toggle
0
0
X
Continuous
0
1
0
Continuous
0
1
1
Toggle
128
8042 KEYBOARD CONTROLLER DESCRIPTION
A Universal Keyboard Controller designed for
intelligent keyboard management in desktop
computer applications is implemented. The
Universal Keyboard Controller uses an 8042
microcontroller CPU core. This section
concentrates on the enhancements to the 8042.
For general information about the 8042, refer to
the "Hardware Description of the 8042" in the 8-
Bit Embedded Controller Handbook.
KIRQ is the Keyboard IRQ
MIRQ is the Mouse IRQ
Port 21 is used to create a GATEA20 signal from the FDC37B72x.
8042A
P27
P10
P26
TST0
P23
TST1
P22
P11
KDAT
KCLK
MCLK
MDAT
Keyboard and Mouse Interface
LS05
129
KEYBOARD ISA INTERFACE
The FDC37B72x ISA interface is functionally
compatible with the 8042-style host interface. It
consists of the D0-7 data bus; the nIOR, nIOW
and the Status register, Input Data register, and
Output Data register. Table 48 shows how the
interface decodes the control signals. In
addition to the above signals, the host interface
includes keyboard and mouse IRQs.
TABLE 56 - ISA I/O ADDRESS MAP
ISA ADDRESS
nIOW
nIOR
BLOCK
FUNCTION (NOTE 1)
0x60
0
1
KDATA
Keyboard Data Write (C/D=0)
1
0
KDATA
Keyboard Data Read
0x64
0
1
KDCTL
Keyboard Command Write (C/D=1)
1
0
KDCTL
Keyboard Status Read
Note 1: These registers consist of three separate 8 bit registers. Status, Data/Command Write and
Data Read.
Keyboard Data Write
This is an 8 bit write only register. When
written, the C/D status bit of the status register
is cleared to zero and the IBF bit is set.
Keyboard Data Read
This is an 8 bit read only register. If enabled by
"ENABLE FLAGS", when read, the KIRQ output
is cleared and the OBF flag in the status register
is cleared. If not enabled, the KIRQ and/or
AUXOBF1 must be cleared in software.
Keyboard Command Write
This is an 8 bit write only register. When
written, the C/D status bit of the status register
is set to one and the IBF bit is set.
Keyboard Status Read
This is an 8 bit read only register. Refer to the
description of the Status Register for more
information.
CPU-to-Host Communication
The FDC37B72x CPU can write to the Output
Data register via register DBB. A write to
this register automatically sets Bit 0 (OBF) in
the Status register. See Table 49.
TABLE 57 - HOST INTERFACE FLAGS
8042 INSTRUCTION
FLAG
OUT DBB
Set OBF, and, if enabled, the KIRQ output signal goes high
130
Host-to-CPU Communication
The host system can send both commands and
data to the Input Data register. The CPU
differentiates between commands and data by
reading the value of Bit 3 of the Status register.
When bit 3 is "1", the CPU interprets the register
contents as a command. When bit 3 is "0", the
CPU interprets the register contents as data.
During a host write operation, bit 3 is set to "1" if
SA2 = 1 or reset to "0" if SA2 = 0.
KIRQ
If "EN FLAGS" has been executed and P24 is
set to a one: the OBF flag is gated onto KIRQ.
The KIRQ signal can be connected to system
interrupt to signify that the FDC37B72x CPU has
written to the output data register via "OUT
DBB,A". If P24 is set to a zero, KIRQ is forced
low. On power-up, after a valid RST pulse has
been delivered to the device, KIRQ is reset to 0.
KIRQ will normally reflects the status of writes
"DBB". (KIRQ is normally selected as IRQ1 for
keyboard support.)
If "EN FLAGS" has not been executed: KIRQ
can be controlled by writing to P24. Writing a
zero to P24 forces KIRQ low; a high forces
KIRQ high.
MIRQ
If "EN FLAGS" has been executed and P25 is
set to a one:; IBF is inverted and gated onto
MIRQ. The MIRQ signal can be connected to
system interrupt to signify that the FDC37B72x
CPU has read the DBB register.
If "EN FLAGS" has not been executed, MIRQ is
controlled by P25, Writing a zero to P25 forces
MIRQ low, a high forces MIRQ high. (MIRQ is
normally selected as IRQ12 for mouse support).
Gate A20
A general purpose P21 is used as a software
controlled Gate A20 or user defined output.
EXTERNAL KEYBOARD AND MOUSE
INTERFACE
Industry-standard PC-AT-compatible keyboards
employ a two-wire, bidirectional TTL interface
for data transmission. Several sources also
supply PS/2 mouse products that employ the
same type of interface. To facilitate system
expansion, the FDC37B72x provides four signal
pins that may be used to implement this
interface directly for an external keyboard and
mouse.
The FDC37B72x has four high-drive, open-drain
output, bidirectional port pins that can be used
for external serial interfaces, such as ISA
external keyboard and PS/2-type mouse
interfaces. They are KCLK, KDAT, MCLK, and
MDAT. P26 is inverted and output as KCLK.
The KCLK pin is connected to TEST0. P27 is
inverted and output as KDAT. The KDAT pin is
connected to P10. P23 is inverted and output as
MCLK. The MCLK pin is connected to TEST1.
P22 is inverted and output as MDAT. The
MDAT pin is connected to P11. NOTE: External
pull-ups may be required.
KEYBOARD POWER MANAGEMENT
The keyboard provides support for two power-
saving modes: soft powerdown mode and hard
powerdown mode. In soft powerdown mode,
the clock to the ALU is stopped but the
timer/counter and interrupts are still active. In
hard power down mode the clock to the 8042 is
stopped.
Soft Power Down Mode
This mode is entered by executing a HALT
instruction. The execution of program code is
halted until either RESET is driven active or a
data byte is written to the DBBIN register by a
master CPU. If this mode is exited using the
interrupt, and the IBF interrupt is enabled, then
program execution resumes with a CALL to the
interrupt routine, otherwise the next instruction
is executed. If it is exited using RESET then a
131
normal reset sequence is initiated and program
execution starts from program memory location
0.
Hard Power Down Mode
Hard Power Down Mode is entered by executing
a STOP instruction. Disabling the oscillator
driver cell stops the oscillator. When either
RESET is driven active or a data byte is written
to the DBBIN register by a master CPU, this
mode will be exited (as above). However, as the
oscillator cell will require an initialization time,
either RESET must be held active for sufficient
time to allow the oscillator to stabilize. Program
execution will resume as above.
INTERRUPTS
The FDC37B72x provides the two 8042
interrupts, the IBF and the Timer/Counter
Overflow.
MEMORY CONFIGURATIONS
The FDC37B72x provides 2K of on-chip ROM
and 256 bytes of on-chip RAM.
Register Definitions
Host I/F Data Register
The Input Data and Output Data registers are
each 8 bits wide. A write to this 8 bit register will
load the Keyboard Data Read Buffer, set the
OBF flag and set the KIRQ output if enabled. A
read of this register will read the data from the
Keyboard Data or Command Write Buffer and
clear the IBF flag. Refer to the KIRQ and Status
register descriptions for more information.
Host I/F Status Register
The Status register is 8 bits wide. Table 50
shows the contents of the Status register.
TABLE 58 - STATUS REGISTER
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
UD
UD
UD
UD
C/D
UD
IBF
OBF
Status Register
This register is cleared on a reset. This register
is read-only for the Host and read/write by the
FDC37B72x CPU.
UD
Writable by FDC37B72x CPU. These
bits are user-definable.
C/D
(Command Data)-This bit specifies
whether the input data register contains
data or a command (0 = data, 1 =
command). During a host
data/command write operation, this bit
is set to "1" if SA2 = 1 or reset to "0" if
SA2 = 0.
IBF
(Input Buffer Full)- This flag is set to 1
whenever the host system writes data
into the input data register. Setting this
flag activates the FDC37B72x CPU's
nIBF (MIRQ) interrupt if enabled. When
the FDC37B72x CPU reads the input
data register (DBB), this bit is
automatically reset and the interrupt is
cleared. There is no output pin
associated with this internal signal.
OBF
(Output Buffer Full) - This flag is set to
whenever the FDC37B72x CPU write to
the output data register (DBB). When
the host system reads the output data
register, this bit is automatically reset.
132
EXTERNAL CLOCK SIGNAL
The FDC37B72x Keyboard Controller clock
source is a 12 MHz clock generated from a
14.318 MHz clock. The reset pulse must last for
at least 24 16 MHz clock periods. The pulse-
width requirement applies to both internally (Vcc
POR) and externally generated reset signals. In
powerdown mode, the external clock signal is
not loaded by the chip.
DEFAULT RESET CONDITIONS
The FDC37B72x has one source of reset: an
external reset via the RESET_DRV pin. Refer to
Table 51 for the effect of each type of reset on
the internal registers.
TABLE 59 - RESETS
DESCRIPTION
HARDWARE RESET (RESET)
KCLK
Input
KDAT
Input
MCLK
Input
MDAT
Input
Host I/F Data Reg
N/A
Host I/F Status Reg
00H
N/A: Not Applicable
GATEA20 AND KEYBOARD RESET
The FDC37B72x provides two options for
GateA20 and Keyboard Reset: 8042 Software
Generated GateA20 and KRESET and Port 92
Fast GateA20 and KRESET.
PORT 92 FAST GATEA20 AND KEYBOARD
RESET
Port 92 Register
This port can only be read or written if Port 92
has been enabled via bit 2 of the KRST_GA20
Register (Logical Device 7, 0xF0) set to 1.
This register is used to support the alternate
reset (nALT_RST) and alternate A20 (ALT_A20)
functions.
NAME
PORT 92
Location
92h
Default Value
24h
Attribute
Read/Write
Size
8 bits
133
Port 92 Register
Bit
Function
7:6
Reserved. Returns 00 when read
5
Reserved. Returns a 1 when read
4
Reserved. Returns a 0 when read
3
Reserved. Returns a 0 when read
2
Reserved. Returns a 1 when read
1
ALT_A20 Signal control. Writing a 0 to this bit causes the ALT_A20 signal to be
driven low. Writing a 1 to this bit causes the ALT_A20 signal to be driven high.
0
Alternate System Reset. This read/write bit provides an alternate system reset
function. This function provides an alternate means to reset the system CPU to
effect a mode switch from Protected Virtual Address Mode to the Real Address
Mode. This provides a faster means of reset than is provided by the Keyboard
controller. This bit is set to a 0 by a system reset. Writing a 1 to this bit will cause
the nALT_RST signal to pulse active (low) for a minimum of 1 µs after a delay of
500 ns. Before another nALT_RST pulse can be generated, this bit must be
written back to a 0.
nGATEA20
8042
P21
ALT_A20
System
nA20M
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
Bit 0 of Port 92, which generates the nALT_RST
signal, is used to reset the CPU under program
control. This signal is AND'ed together
externally with the reset signal (nKBDRST) from
the keyboard controller to provide a software
means of resetting the CPU. This provides a
faster means of reset than is provided by the
keyboard controller. Writing a 1 to bit 0 in the
Port 92 Register causes this signal to pulse low
for a minimum of 6µs, after a delay of a
minimum of 14µs. Before another nALT_RST
pulse can be generated, bit 0 must be set to 0
either by a system reset of a write to Port 92.
Upon reset, this signal is driven inactive high (bit
0 in the Port 92 Register is set to 0).
If Port 92 is enabled, i.e., bit 2 of KRST_GA20 is
set to 1, then a pulse is generated by writing a 1
to bit 0 of the Port 92 Register and this pulse is
AND'ed with the pulse generated from the 8042.
This pulse is output on pin KRESET and its
polarity is controlled by the GPI/O polarity
configuration.
134
Bit 1 of Port 92, the ALT_A20 signal, is used to
force nA20M to the CPU low for support of real
mode compatible software. This signal is
externally OR'ed with the A20GATE signal from
the keyboard controller and CPURST to control
the nA20M input of the CPU. Writing a 0 to bit 1
of the Port 92 Register forces ALT_A20 low.
ALT_A20 low drives nA20M to the CPU low, if
A20GATE from the keyboard controller is also
low. Writing a 1 to bit 1 of the Port 92 Register
forces ALT_A20 high. ALT_A20 high drives
nA20M to the CPU high, regardless of the state
of A20GATE from the keyboard controller.
Upon reset, this signal is driven low.
8042 P17 Functions
8042 function P17 is implemented as in a true
8042 part. Reference the 8042 spec for all
timing. A port signal of 0 drives the output to 0.
A port signal of 1 causes the port enable signal
to drive the output to 1 within 20-30nsec. After
several (# TBD) clocks, the port enable goes
away and the internal 90µA pull-up maintains
the output signal as 1.
8042
P92
Pulse
Gen
KBDRST
KRST_GA20
Bit 2
Bit 0
P20
KRST
nALT_RST
6us
14us
~ ~
6us
14us
~ ~
Note: When Port 92 is disabled,
writes are ignored and reads
return undefined values.
KRESET Generation
135
In 8042 mode, the pins can be programmed as
open drain. When programmed in open drain
mode, the port enables do not come into play. If
the port signal is 0 the output will be 0. If the
port signal is 1, the output tristates: an external
pull-up can pull the pin high, and the pin can be
shared i.e., P17 and nSMI can be externally tied
together. In 8042 mode, the pins cannot be
programmed as input nor inverted through the
GP configuration registers.
0ns
250ns
500ns
CLK
AEN
nAEN
64=I/O Addr
n64
nIOW
nA
DD1
nDD1
nCNTL
nIOW'
nIOW+n64
AfterD1
nAfterD1
60=I/O Addr
n60
nIOW+n60=B
nAfterD1+B
D[1]
GA20
Gate A20 Turn-On Sequence Timing
When writing to the command and data port
with hardware speedup, the IOW timing shown
in the figure titled "IOW Timing for Port 92" in
the Timing Diagrams Section is used. This
setup time is only required to be met when using
hardware speedup; the data must be valid a
minimum of 0 nsec from the leading edge of the
write and held throughout the entire write cycle.
136
SOFT POWER MANAGEMENT
This chip employs soft power management to
allow the chip to enter low power mode and to
provide a variety of wakeup events to power up
the chip. This technique allows for software
control over powerdown and wakeup events. In
low power mode, the chip runs off of the trickle
voltage, VTR. In this mode, the chip is ready to
power up from either the power button or from
one of a number of wakeup events including
pressing a key, touching the mouse or receiving
data from one of the UARTs. The alarm can
also be set to power up the system at a
predetermined time to perform one or more
tasks.
The implementation of Soft Power Management
is illustrated in Figure 11. A high to low
transition on the Button input or on any of the
enabled wakeup events (SPx) causes the
nPowerOn output to go active low which turns
on the main power supply. Even if the power
supply is completely lost (i.e., VTR is not
present) the power supply can still be turned on
upon the return of VTR. This is accomplished
by a VTR power on reset if the VTR_POR_EN
bit is enabled. The chip can also be
programmed to always stay off when the AC
power returns if the VTR_POR_OFF bit is
enabled. These bits are located in the Soft
Power Enable Register 2 in Logical Device 8 at
0xB1.
The Button input can be used to turn off the
power supply after a debounce delay. The
power supply can also be turned off under
software control (via a write to register
WDT_CTRL with bit 7 set).
Configuration registers L8-CR_B0 and L8-
CR_B1 select the wake-up events (SPx). The
Configuration registers L8-CR_B2 and L8-
CR_B3 indict the wake-up event status. The
possible wake-events are:
§
UART1 and UART 2 Ring Indicator Pin
§
Keyboard and Mouse clock Pin
§
Group Interrupt 1, Group Interrupt 2
§
IRRX2 input pin
§
UART 1 and UART 2 Receive Data Pin
§
nRING pin
§
Power Button input pin
§
VTR_POR
137
FIGURE 5 - SOFT POWER MANAGEMENT FUNCTIONAL DIAGRAM
Note 1:
All soft power management functions run off of VTR. When VTR is not present, Vbat
supplies power to Flip Flop 1.
Note 2: Flip Flop 1 is battery backed-up so that it returns the last valid state of the machine.
Note 3: A battery backed-up enable bit in the alarm control register can be set to force Flip Flop 1 to
come up `off' after a VTR POR, the VTR_POR_OFF bit. A similar bit can be set to force Flip
Flop 1 to come up `on' after a VTR POR, the VTR_POR_EN bit. These bits are in the Soft
Power Enable Register 2 in Logical Device 8 at 0xB1, defined as follows.
Bit 4 ­ VTR_POR_OFF
If VTR_POR_OFF is set, the nPowerOn pin will go inactive (float) and the main power (Vcc)
will remain off when the VTR POR occurs. The software must not set VTR_POR_OFF and
VTR_POR_EN at the same time.
BIT 6 - VTR_POR_EN
If VTR_POR_EN is set, the nPowerOn pin will go active (low) and the machine will power-up
as soon as a VTR POR occurs. The software must not set VTR_POR_OFF and
VTR_POR_EN at the same time.
A transition on the Button input, or on any enabled
inputs causes the nPowerOn output to go active low.
A low pulse on the Soft Power Off signal, a Vbat POR, a VTR POR with Vbat<1.2V, or Power Button Override Event causes
nPowerOn to float.
ED;PG = Edge Detect, Pulse Generator
ED;L = Edge Detect and Latch
EN1
ENx
D
Q
CLR
Button Input
SP1
SPx
Open Collector
Type Output
Soft Power
Off
nPowerOn
VTR
nSPOFF1
nSPOFF1
ED; PG
ED; L
ED; L
Alarm
OFF_EN
nSPOFF1
nSPOFF
Delay1
OFF_DLY
Delay2
nBINT
OFF_DLY
Logic
L
Button
V
BAT
POR
AL_REM_EN
Flip
Flop 1
VTR POR
VTR_POR_EN
Logic
Logic
Override
Timer
PWRBTNOR_STS
PWRBTNOR_EN
nSPOFF1
V
TR
POR With
Vbat<1.2V
V
TR_
POR_OFF
VTR POR
SPx
138
REGISTERS
The following registers can be accessed when in
configuration mode at Logical Device 8,
Registers B0-B3, B8 and F4, and when not in
configuration they can be accessed through the
Index and Data Register. All soft power
management configuration registers are battery
backed up and are reset on Vbat POR.
Soft Power Enable Registers
Soft Power Enable Register 1
(Configuration Register B0, Logical Device 8)
This register contains the enable bits for the
wake-up function of the nPowerOn bit. When
enabled, these bits allow their corresponding
function to turn on power to the system.
Soft Power Enable Register 2
(Configuration Register B1, Logical Device 8)
This register contains additional enable bits for
the wake-up function of the nPowerOn bit.
When enabled, these bits allow their
corresponding function to turn on power to the
system. It also contains the VTR_POR_EN and
VTR_POR_OFF bits, as well as the OFF_EN
bit, which is defined as follows: After power up,
this bit defaults to 1, i.e., enabled. This bit
allows the software to enable or disable the
button control of power off.
Soft Power Status Registers
Soft Power Status Register 1
(Configuration Register B2, Logical Device 8)
This register contains the status for the wake-up
events. Note: The status bit gets set if the
wakeup event occurs, whether or not it is
enabled as a wakeup function by setting the
corresponding bit in Soft Power Enable Register
1. However, only the enabled wakeup functions
will turn on power to the system.
Soft Power Status Register 2
(Configuration Register B3, Logical Device 8)
This register contains additional status for the
wake-up events. Note: The status bit gets set if
the wakeup event occurs, whether or not it is
enabled as a wakeup function by setting the
corresponding bit in Soft Power Enable Register
2. However, only the enabled wakeup functions
will turn on power to the system.
Soft Power Control Registers
WDT_CTRL
(Configuration Register F4, Logical Device 8)
This register is used for soft power management
and watchdog timer control. Bits [7:5] are for
soft power management: SPOFF, Restart_Cnt,
Stop_Cnt.
Delay 2 Time Set Register
(Configuration Register B8, Logical Device 8)
This register is used to set Delay 2 to value from
500msec to 32sec. The default value is
500msec.
139
BUTTON OVERRIDE FEATURE
The power button has an override event as
required by the ACPI specification. If the user
presses the power button for more than four
seconds while the system is in the working
state, a hardware event is generated and the
system will transition to the off state. There are
status bits and enable bits associated with this
feature in the PM1_BLK registers. See the ACPI
section.
This override event utilizes power button logic to
determine that the power button (Button_In) has
been pressed for more that four seconds. The
override enable/disable bit, PWRBTNOR_EN,
allows this override function to be turned on/off.
If enabled, this override event will result in
setting the override status bit,
PWRBTNOR_STS (to be cleared by writing a 1
to its bit position - writing a 0 has no effect),
clearing the regular button status bit,
PWRBTN_STS, and generating an event to be
routed into the soft power management logic to
turn off the system. The override status bit
alerts the system upon power-up that an
override event was used to power down the
system, and will be used to properly power-up
the system.
Figure 11 shows the soft power management
logic with the override timer path from the
button input. The override timer counts while
the button is held (in the present implementation
this would be when the button input is high) and
is cleared upon release of the button. It has a
0.5 second or faster resolution (run off of the
32kHz clock divided down) and the minimum
time for triggering the override power down is
four seconds, with a maximum of 4.5 seconds.
The timer output will pulse the clear on the Flip
Flop 1.
Figure 12 illustrates the timing of the blanking
period relative to Button_In and nPowerOn for
the override event.
140
FIGURE 6 - BLANKING PERIOD
Button_In
nPowerOn
Blanking Period
Vcc
4+
sec
Release
sec
4
sec
4
141
ACPI/PME/SMI FEATURES
ACPI FEATURES
The FDC37B72x supports ACPI as described in
this section. These features comply with the
ACPI Specification, Revision 1.0.
Legacy/ACPI Select Capability
This capability consists of an SMI/SCI switch
which is required in a system that supports both
legacy and ACPI power management models.
This is due to the fact that the system software
for legacy power management consists of the
SMI interrupt handler while for ACPI it consists
of the ACPI driver (SCI interrupt handler). This
support uses Logical Device A at 0x0A to hold
the address pointers to the ACPI power
management register block, PM1_BLK, which
consists of run-time registers. Included in the
PM1_BLK is an enable bit, SCI_EN, to allow the
SCI interrupt to be generated upon an enabled
SCI event. This SCI interrupt can be switched
out to the nPME/SCI pin or routed to one of the
parallel interrupts. The polarity and output type
(open collector or push-pull) of the SCI is
selected through the IRQ MUX Register.
The software power management events (those
that generate an SMI in legacy mode and an
SCI in ACPI mode) are controlled by the
EN_SMI and SCI_EN bits. The SCI enable bit,
SCI_EN, is located in the PM1_CNTRL register,
bit 0. This bit is used in conjunction with
EN_SMI, bit 7 of the SMI enable register 2, to
enable either SCI or SMI (or both). For legacy
power management, the EN_SMI bit is used; if
set, it routes the power management events to
the SMI interrupt logic. For ACPI power
management, the SCI_EN bit is used; if set, it
routes the power management events to the SCI
interrupt logic.
Power Button With Override
The power button has a status and and enable
bit in the PM1_BLK of registers to provide an
SCI upon the button press. The power button
can also turn the system on and off through the
soft power management logic. The power
button also has an override event as required by
the ACPI specification. See The Soft Power
Management Section. This override event is
described as follows: If the user presses the
power button for more than 4 seconds while the
system is in the working state, a hardware event
is generated and the system will transition to the
off state. There are status and enable bits
associated with this feature in the PM1_BLK
registers.
General Purpose ACPI Events
The General Purpose ACPI events are enabled
through the SCI_EN1 bit in the GPE_EN
register. This bit, if set, allows any of the
enabled PME events to generate an SCI. In
addition, if the DEVINT_EN bit in the PME_EN 1
Register is set, and if the EN_SMI_PME bit in
the SMI_EN 2 register is set, then any of the
SMI Events can also generate an SCI. See the
SCI/PME and SMI/PME logic diagrams below.
Device Sleep States
Each device in the FDC37B72x supports two
device sleep states, D0 (on) and D3 (off). With
all devices off, the part is powered either by
main power (Vcc) or standby power (Vtr),
depending on the system sleep state. In both
cases, the part can provide wakeup capability
through the soft power management logic and
generate a nPME or nSCI. In an ACPI system,
the devices are powered on and off through
control methods.
142
Wake Events
Wake events are events that turn power on
(activate nPowerOn output) if enabled. These
events can also be enabled as SMI, SCI and
nPME events as shown in the following table. In
addition, these wake events set the WAK_STS
bit if enabled (see ACPI PM1_STS2 Register
description).
WAKE EVENTS
INPUT TO SOFT POWER
MANAGEMENT
SMI/SCI/PME
GENERATION
PINS
KDAT
KDAT
SMI/SCI/PME
MDAT
MDAT
SMI/SCI/PME
IRRX2
IRRX2
SMI/SCI/PME
RXD2/IRRX
RXD2/IRRX
SMI/SCI/PME
RXD1
RXD1
SMI/SCI
1
/PME
1
nRI1
nRI1
SMI/SCI/PME
nRI2
nRI2
SMI/SCI/PME
nRING
nRING
SMI/SCI/PME
Button
Button
SMI/SCI
2
/PME
1
GP10-17
3
GPINT1
SMI/SCI
1
/PME
GP50-54, GP60-67
GPINT2
SMI/SCI
1
/PME
1
INTERNAL
SIGNALS
VTR POR
VTR POR
SCI
Note 1: These SCI/PME events are SMI events that are enabled through DEVINT_EN.
Note 2: These SCI events have Status and Enable bits in the PM1 registers.
Note 3: The polarity of the edge that causes the event is programmable through the polarity bit in the
GPIO configuration registers. The default is the low-to-high edge.
The following are SMI events that are not wake events:
·
Floppy Interrupt
·
Parallel Port Interrupt
·
WDT
·
P12
Any wakeup logic that affects the configuration of the wakeup events is implemented so that the
configuration of the wakeup events is retained (in the event of total power loss) upon Vtr POR.
143
PME SUPPORT
The FDC37B72x offers support for PCI power
management events (PMEs). A power
management event is requested by a PCI
function via the assertion of the nPME signal.
The assertion and deassertion of nPME is
asynchronous to the PCI clock. In the
FDC37B72x, active transitions on the ring
indicator inputs nRI1 and nRI2 or the nRING
pin, active keyboard-data edges, active mouse-
data edges and GPIOs GP10-GP17 can directly
assert the nPME signal. In addition, if the
DEVINT_EN bit in the PME_EN 1 Register is
set, and if the EN_SMI_PME bit in the SMI_EN
2 register is set, then any of the SMI Events can
also generate a nPME. See the SCI/PME and
SMI/PME logic diagrams below.
nPME functionality is controlled by the runtime
registers at <PM1_BLK>+Ch through
<PM1_BLK>+11h. The PME Enable bit,
PME_EN, globally controls PME Wake-up
events. When PME_EN is inactive, the nPME
signal can not be asserted. When PME_EN is
asserted, any wake source whose individual
PME Wake Enable register bit is asserted can
cause nPME to become asserted. The PME
Wake Status register indicates which wake
source has asserted the nPME signal. The PME
Status bit, PME_STS, is asserted by active
transitions of PME Wake sources. PME_STS
will become asserted independent of the state of
the global PME enable, PME_EN.
In the FDC37B72x the nPME pin is an open
drain, active low, driver. The FDC37B72x nPME
pin is fully isolated from other external devices
that might pull the PCI nPME signal low; i.e., the
PCI nPME signal is capable of being driven high
externally by another active device or pullup
even when the the FDC37B72x VDD is
grounded, providing VTR power is active. The
FDC37B72x nPME driver sinks 6mA at .55V
max (see section 4.2.1.1 DC Specifications,
page 122, in the PCI Local Bus Specification,
Revision 2.1).
ACPI, PME AND SMI REGISTERS
Logical Device A in the configuration section
contains the address pointer to the ACPI power
management register block, and PM1_BLK.
These are run-time registers; Included in the
PM1_BLK is an enable bit to allow the SCI
group interrupt to be routed to any interrupt or
onto the nPME/SCI pin. Note: See IRQ mux
control register for SCI/PME/SMI selection
function and pin configuration bits.
Register Description
The ACPI register model consists of a number
of fixed register blocks that perform designated
functions. A register block consists of a number
of registers that perform Status, Enable and
Control functions. The ACPI specification deals
with events (which have an associated interrupt
status and enable bits, and sometimes an
associated control function) and control
features. The status registers illustrate what
defined function is requesting ACPI interrupt
services (SCI). Any status bit in the ACPI
specification has the following attributes:
A. Status bits are only set through some
defined "hardware event."
B. Unless otherwise noted, Status bits are
cleared by writing a "HIGH" to that bit
position, and upon VTR POR. Writing
a 0 has no effect.
C. Status bits only generate interrupts
while their associated bit in the enable
register is set.
D. Function bit positions in the status
register have the same bit position in
the enable register (there are
exceptions to this rule, special status
bits have no enables).
Note that this implies that if the respective
enable bit is reset and the hardware event
occurs, the respective status bit is set, however
no interrupt is generated until the enable bit is
set. This allows software to test the state of the
event (by examining the status bit) without
necessarily generating an interrupt. There are a
144
special class of status bits that have no
respective enable bit, these are called out
specifically, and the respective enable bit in the
enable register is marked as reserved for these
special cases.
The enable registers allow the setting of the
status bit to generate an interrupt. As a general
rule there is an enable bit in the enable register
for every status bit in the status register. The
control register provides special controls for the
associated event, or special control features that
are not associated with an interrupt event. The
ordering of a register block is the status
registers, followed by enable registers, followed
by control registers.
Table 11 and 12 list the PM1/GPE and
PME/SMI/MSC register blocks and the locations
of the registers contained in these blocks. All of
these registers are powered by VTR and battery
backed-up and are reset on Vbat POR.
Wakeup Event Configuration is Retained by
Battery Power
To preserve the configuration of the wakeup
functions that were programmed prior to the
loss of Vtr upon its return, the soft power
management registers, PME, SCI, SMI registers
and GPIO registers are all powered by the
battery. These registers are reset to their
default values only on Vbat POR. These
registers are described in the sections below.
145
Register Block
The registers in this block are powered by VTR and battery backed up.
TABLE 60 - PM1/GPE REGISTER BLOCK
REGISTER
SIZE
ADDRESS
PM1_STS 1
8
<PM1_BLK>
PM1_STS 2
8
<PM1_BLK>+1h
PM1_EN 1
8
<PM1_BLK>+2h
PM1_EN 2
8
<PM1_BLK>+3h
PM1_CNTRL 1
8
<PM1_BLK>+4h
PM1_CNTRL 2
8
<PM1_BLK>+5h
Reserved
8
<PM1_BLK>+6h
Reserved
8
<PM1_BLK>+7h
GPE_STS 1
8
<PM1_BLK>+8h
GPE_EN 1
8
<PM1_BLK>+9h
Reserved
8
<PM1_BLK>+Ah
Reserved
8
<PM1_BLK>+Bh
TABLE 61 - PME/SMI/MSC REGISTER BLOCK
REGISTER
SIZE
ADDRESS
PME_STS 1
8
< PM1_BLK>+Ch
PME_STS 2
8
< PM1_BLK>+Dh
PME_EN 1
8
< PM1_BLK>+Eh
PME_EN 2
8
< PM1_BLK>+Fh
PME_STS
8
< PM1_BLK>+10h
PME_EN
8
< PM1_BLK>+11h
SMI_STS 1
8
< PM1_BLK>+12h
SMI_STS 2
8
< PM1_BLK>+13h
SMI_EN 1
8
< PM1_BLK>+14h
SMI_EN 2
8
< PM1_BLK>+15h
MSC_STS
8
< PM1_BLK>+16h
Reserved
8
< PM1_BLK>+17h
Table 62 shows the block size and range of base addresses for each block.
TABLE 62 - REGISTER BLOCK ATTRIBUTES
BLOCK NAME
BLOCK SIZE
BASE ADDRESS RANGE
PM1_BLK
24-bytes
0-FFF
146
ACPI Registers
In the FDC37B72x, the PME wakeup events can be enabled as SCI events through the SCI_STS1 and
SCI_EN1 bits in the GPE status and enable registers. See PME Interface and SMI/PME/SCI logic
sections.
Power Management 1 Status Register 1 (PM1_STS 1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK> System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
Note 1: This bit is set by hardware and can only be cleared by software writing a one to this bit
position and by Vbat POR. Writing a 0 has no effect.
147
Power Management 1 Status Register 2 (PM1_STS 2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+1h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
PWRBTN_STS
This bit is set when the Button_In signal is asserted. In the
system working state, while PWRBTN_EN and
PWRBTN_STS are both set an SCI interrupt event is raised.
In the sleeping or soft off state, a wake-up event is generated
(regardless of the setting of PWRBTN_EN) (Note 2). This bit
is only set by hardware and is reset by software writing a one
to this bit position, and by Vbat POR. Writing a 0 has no
effect. It is also reset as follows: If PWRBTNOR_EN is set,
and if the Button_In signal is held asserted for more than four
seconds, then this bit is cleared, the PWRBTNOR_STS bit is
set and the system will transition into the soft off state
(nPowerOn floats).
1
Reserved
Reserved.
2
Reserved
Reserved
3
PWRBTNOR_STS
This bit is set when the power switch over-ride function is set:
If PWRBTNOR_EN is set, and if the Button_In signal is held
asserted for more than four seconds. Hardware is also
required to reset the PWRBTN_STS when issuing a power
switch over-ride function. (Note 1)
4-6
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
7
WAK_STS
This bit is set when the system is in the sleeping state and an
enabled wakeup event occurs. This bit is set on the high-to-
low transition of nPowerOn, if the WAK_CTRL bit in the sleep
/ wake configuration register (0xF0 in Logical Device A) is
cleared. If the WAK_CTRL bit is set, then any enabled
wakeup event will also set the WAK_STS bit in addition to the
high-to-low transition of nPowerOn. It is cleared by writing a 1
to its bit location when nPowerOn is active (low). Upon setting
this bit, the system will transition to the working state. (Note
1)
Note 1: This bit is set by hardware and can only be cleared by software writing a one to this bit
position and by Vbat POR. Writing a 0 has no effect.
Nore 2: In the present implementation of Button_In, pressing the button will always wake the machine
(i.e., activate nPowerOn).
148
Power Management 1 Enable Register 1 (PM1_EN 1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+2 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
Power Management 1 Enable Register 2 (PM1_EN 2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+3 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
PWRBTN_EN
This bit is used to enable the assertion of the Button_In to
generate an SCI event. The PWRBTN_STS bit is set
anytime the Button_In signal is asserted. The enable bit
does not have to be set to enable the setting of the
PWRBTN_STS bit by the assertion of the Button_In signal.
1-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
Power Management 1 Control Register 1 (PM1_CNTRL 1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+4 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
SCI_EN
When this bit is set, then the enabled SCI power
management events generate an SCI interrupt. When this bit
is reset power management events do not generate an SCI
interrupt.
1-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
149
Power Management 1 Control Register 2 (PM1_CNTRL 2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+5 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
Reserved
Reserved. This field always returns zero.
1
PWRBTNOR_EN
This bit controls the power button over-ride function. When set, then
anytime the Button_In signal is asserted for more than four seconds
the system will transition to the off state. When a power button over-
ride event occurs, the logic clears the PWRBTN_STS bit, and sets
the PWRBTNOR_STS bit.
2-4
SLP_TYPx
This 3-bit field defines the type of hardware sleep state the system
enters when the SLP_EN bit is set to one. When this field is 000 the
FDC37B72x will transition the machine to the off state when the
SLP_EN bit is set to one. That is, with this field set to 000,
nPowerOn will go inactive (float) after a 1-2 clock delay when
SLP_EN is set. This delay is a minimum of one 32kHz clock and a
maximum of two 32kHz clocks (31.25
µ
sec-62.5
µ
sec). When this
field is any other value, there is no effect.
5
SLP_EN
This is a write-only bit and reads to it always return a zero. Writing
`1' to this bit causes the system to sequence into the sleeping state
associated with the SLP_TYPx fields after a 1-2 clock delay, if the
SLP_CTRL bit in the sleep / wake configuration register (0xF0 in
Logical Device A) is cleared. If the SLP_CTRL bit is set, do not
sequence into the sleeping state associated with the SLP_TYPx
field, but generate an SMI. Note: the SLP_EN_SMI bit in the SMI
Status Register 2 is always set upon writing `1' to the SLP_EN bit.
Writing `0' to this bit has no effect.
6-7
Reserved
Reserved. This field always returns zero.
General Purpose Event Status Register 1 (GPE_STS1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+8 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
SCI_STS1
This bit is set when the device power management events (PME
events) occur. When enabled, the setting of this bit will generate an
SCI interrupt. (Note 1)
1-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
Note 1: This bit is set by hardware and can only be cleared by software writing a one to this bit
position and by Vbat POR. Writing a 0 has no effect.
150
General Purpose Event Enable Register 1 (GPE_EN1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+9 System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DESCRIPTION
0
SCI_EN1
When this bit is set, then the enabled device power management events
(PME events) will generate an SCI interrupt. When this bit is reset,
device power management events will not generate an SCI interrupt.
1-7
Reserved
Reserved. These bits always return a value of zero.
Note 0: all bits described as "reserved" in writeable registers must be written with the value 0 when the
register is written.
PME Registers
The power management event function has a PME_Status bit and a PME_En bit. These bits are
defined in the PCI Bus Power Management Interface Specification, Revision 1.0, Draft, Copyright
©
1997, PCI Special Interest Group, Mar. 18, 1997.
The default states for the PME_Status and PME_En bits are controlled by V
bat
Power-On-Reset.
PME Status Register (PME_STS)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+10h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
RESERVED
PME_Status
0x00
·
The PME_Status bit is set when the FDC37B72x would normally assert the PCI nPME signal,
independent of the state of the PME_En bit. Only active transitions on the PME Wake sources
can set the PME_Status bit.
·
The PME_Status bit is read/write-clear. Writing a "1" to the PME_Status bit will clear it and cause
the FDC37B72x to stop asserting the nPME, if enabled.
·
Writing a "0" has no effect on the PME_Status bit.
·
The PME_Status bit is reset to "0" during VBAT Power-On-Reset.
151
PME Enable Register (PME_EN)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+11h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
RESERVED
PME_En
0x00
·
Setting the PME_En bit to "1" enables the FDC37B72x to assert the nPME signal.
·
When the PME_En bit is reset to "0", nPME signal assertion is disabled.
·
The PME_En bit is reset to "0" during VBAT Power-On-Reset.
PME Status Register 1 (PME_STS 1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+Ch System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
DEVINT_STS
Reserved
nRING
MOUSE
KBD
RI1
RI2
Reserved
0x00
PME Status Register 2 (PME_STS2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+Dh System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
GP17
GP16
GP15
GP14
GP13
GP12
GP11
GP10
0x00
·
The PME Status registers indicate the state of the individual FDC37B72x PME wake sources,
independent of the state of the individual source enables or the PME_En bit.
·
If the wake source has asserted a wake event, the associated PME Status bit will be "1". The
wake source bits in the PME Status registers are read/write-clear: an active ("1") PME Status bit
can only be cleared by writing a "1" to the bit. Writing a "0" to bits in the PME Wake Status
register has no effect.
PME Enable Register 1 (PME_EN1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+Eh System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
DEVINT_EN
Reserved
nRING
MOUSE
KBD
RI1
RI2
Reserved
0x00
152
PME Enable Register 2 (PME_EN2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+Fh System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
DEFAULT
GP17
GP16
GP15
GP14
GP13
GP12
GP11
GP10
0x00
·
The PME Enable registers enable the individual FDC37B72x wake sources onto the nPME bus.
·
When the PME Enable register bit for a wake source is active ("1"), if the source asserts a wake
event and the PME_En bit is "1", the source will assert the PCI nPME signal.
·
When the PME Enable register bit for a wake source is inactive ("0"), the PME Status register will
indicate the state of the wake source but will not assert the PCI nPME signal.
SMI Registers
The FDC37B72x implements a group nSMI output pin. The nSMI group interrupt output consists of the
enabled interrupts from each of the functional blocks in the chip plus other SMI events. The interrupts
are enabled onto the group nSMI output via the SMI Enable Registers 1 and 2. The nSMI output is
then enabled onto the group nSMI output pin via bit[7] in the SMI Enable Register 2. These SMI
events can also be enabled as nPME/SCI events by setting the EN_SMI_PME bit, bit[6] of SMI Enable
Register 2.
This register is also used to enable the group nSMI output onto the nSMI Serial/Parallel IRQ pin and
the routing of 8042 P12 internally to nSMI.
SMI Status Register 1 (SMI_STS1)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+12h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write
Size:
8-bits
NAME
DESCRIPTION
SMI Status Register 1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
This register is used to read the status of the SMI inputs.
The following bits must be cleared at their source.
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit[1] PINT (Parallel Port Interrupt)
Bit[2] U2INT (UART 2 Interrupt)
Bit[3] U1INT (UART 1 Interrupt)
Bit[4] FINT (Floppy Disk Controller Interrupt)
Bit[5] GPINT2 (Group Interrupt 2)
Bit[6] GPINT1 (Group Interrupt 1)
Bit[7] WDT (Watch Dog Timer)
153
SMI Status Register 2 (SMI_STS2)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+13h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write
Size:
8-bits
NAME
DESCRIPTION
SMI Status Register 2
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
This register is used to read the status of the SMI inputs.
Bit[0] MINT: Mouse Interrupt. Cleared at source.
Bit[1] KINT: Keyboard Interrupt. Cleared at source.
Bit[2] IRINT: This bit is set by a transition on the IR pin (RXD2 or IRRX2
as selected by Bit 6 of Configuration Register 0xF1 in Logical Device 5,
i.e., after the MUX). Cleared by a read of this register.
Bit[3] BINT: Cleared by a read of this register.
Bit[4] P12: 8042 P1.2. Cleared at source
Bits[5:6] Reserved
Bit[7] SLP_EN_SMI. The SLP_EN SMI status bit. Cleared by a read of
this register. (See Sleep Enable Config Reg.)
0=no SMI due to setting SLP_EN bit
1=SMI generated due to setting SLP_EN bit.
SMI Enable Register 1 (SMI_EN1)
Register Location:
< PM1_BLK >+14h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write
Size:
8-bits
NAME
DESCRIPTION
SMI Enable Register 1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
This register is used to enable the different interrupt sources onto the
group nSMI output.
1=Enable
0=Disable
Bit[0] EN_RING
Note: the PME status bit for RING is used as the SMI status bit for
RING (see PME Status Register).
Bit[1] EN_PINT
Bit[2] EN_U2INT
Bit[3] EN_U1INT
Bit[4] EN_FINT
Bit[5] EN_GPINT2
Bit[6] EN_GPINT1
Bit[7] EN_WDT
154
SMI Enable Register 2 (SMI_EN2)
Register Location:
< PM1_BLK >+15h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write
Size:
8-bits
NAME
DESCRIPTION
SMI Enable
Register 2
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
This register is used to enable the different interrupt sources onto the group
nSMI output, and the group nSMI output onto the nSMI GPI/O pin.
Unless otherwise noted,
1=Enable
0=Disable
Bit[0] EN_MINT
Bit[1] EN_KINT
Bit[2] EN_IRINT
Bit[3] EN_BINT
Bit[4] EN_P12: Enable 8042 P1.2 to route internally to nSMI
0=Do not route to nSMI
1=Enable routing to nSMI.
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] EN_SMI_PME: Enable the group nSMI output into the PME interface
logic.
0= Group SMI output does not go to PME interface logic
1= Enable group SMI output to PME interface logic
Bit[7] EN_SMI: Enable the group nSMI output onto the nSMI pin or Serial
IRQ frame (IRQ2).
0=SMI pin floats
1=Enable group nSMI output onto nSMI pin or serial IRQ frame
Note: the selection of either the nSMI pin or serial IRQ frame is done via bit
7 of the IRQ Mux Control Register (0xC0 in Logical Device 8).
155
Either Edge Triggered Interrupts
Four GPIO pins are implemented that allow an
interrupt to be generated on both a high-to-low
and a low-to-high edge transition, instead of one
or the other as selected by the polarity bit.
The either edge triggered interrupts function as
follows: Selecting the Either Edge Triggered
Interrupt (EETI) function for these GPIO pins is
applicable when the combined interrupt is
enabled for the GPIO pin (GPINT1 for GP11
and GP12, and GPINT2 for GP53 and GP54).
Otherwise, selection of the EETI function will
produce no function for the pin. If the EETI
function is selected for the GPIO pin, then the
bits that control input/output, polarity and open
collector/push-pull have no effect on the function
of the pin. However, the polarity bit does affect
the value of the GP bit (i.e., register GP1, bit 2
for GP12).
An interrupt occurs if the status bit is set and the
interrupt is enabled. The status bits indicate
which of the EETI interrupts transitioned. These
status bits are located in the MSC_STS register.
The status is valid whether or not the interrupt is
enabled and whether or not the EETI function is
selected for the pin.
Miscellaneous Status Register
The MSC_STS register is implemented as follows to hold the status bits of these four GPIOs.
Miscellaneous Status Register (PM1_STS)
Register Location:
<PM1_BLK>+16h System I/O Space
Default Value:
00h on Vbat POR
Attribute:
Read/Write (Note 0)
Size:
8-bits
BIT
NAME
DEFINITION
0
EETI1_STS
Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Input 1 Status. This bit is set when
an edge occurs on the GP11 pin. This bit is cleared by writing a 1
to this bit position (writing a 0 has no effect).
1
EETI2_STS
Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Input 2 Status. This bit is set when
an edge occurs on the GP12 pin. This bit is cleared by writing a 1
to this bit position (writing a 0 has no effect).
2
EETI3_STS
Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Input 3 Status. This bit is set when
an edge occurs on the GP53 pin. This bit is cleared by writing a 1
to this bit position (writing a 0 has no effect).
3
EETI4_STS
Either Edge Triggered Interrupt Input 4 Status. This bit is set when
an edge occurs on the GP54 pin. This bit is cleared by writing a 1
to this bit position (writing a 0 has no effect).
4
VTRPOR_STS
This bit is set upon VTR POR. This bit is cleared by writing a 1 to
this bit position (writing a 0 has no effect). Additionally, when the
system turns on (nPowerOn active low) due to a VTR POR, then
an SCI is generated.
5-7
Reserved
Reserved. This bit always returns zero.
156
SMI/PME/SCI Logic
The logic for the SMI, PME and SCI signals is shown in the figures that follow.
FIGURE 7 - PME/SCI LOGIC
PME_EN1 Register
PME_STS1 Register
PME_EN2 Register
PME_STS2 Register
RI2
RI1
KBD
MOUSE
EN_RI2
EN_RI1
EN_KBD
EN_MOUSE
EN_RING
EN_DEVINT
Enable bit
Key to Symbols
PME#
pin
PME_EN
PME_STS
GP11
GP12
GP13
GP14
EN_GP11
EN_GP12
EN_GP13
EN_GP14
EN_GP15
EN_GP16
EN_GP17
GP10
EN_GP10
GP15
GP16
GP17
DEV_INT
RING
From
SMI/PME
Device
Interrupt
Block
PME_EN
Registers
PME_STS
Registers
Sticky Status bit: Cleared by software
writing a `1' to its bit location
SCI_EN
SCI_EN1
GPE_EN.0
SCI_STS1
GPE_STS.0
GPE_EN
Register
GPE_STS
Register
SCI#
on IRQx
pin
SCI#
on Serial
IRQx
Bit[2] of IRQ Mux
Control Register
IRQ9
Bits[6:5]
of IRQ
Mux Control
Register
SCI#
PME#
Bit[5]
MUX
Bit[6]
0 0
0 1
1 0
WAK_CTRL
WAK_STS
nPowerOn
PWRBTN_EN
PWRBTN_STS
PM1_BLK
157
FIGURE 8 - SMI/PME LOGIC
EN_MINT
EN_KINT
EN_IRINT
EN_BINT
EN_P12
SMI_EN1 Register
SMI_STS1 Register
SMI_EN2 Register
SMI_STS2 Register
SMI_EN
Registers
SMI_STS
Registers
PINT
U2INT
U1INT
FINT
GPINT1
WDT
EN_PINT
EN_U2INT
EN_U1INT
EN_FINT
EN_GPINT2
EN_GPINT1
EN_WDT
MINT
KINT
IRINT
BINT
P12
Interrupt Status bit: Cleared at
source
Enable bit
Key to Symbols
SMI#
EN_SMI
Bit 7
of SMI_EN2
Register
out to pin
or Serial
IRQ2
Group
SMI
DEV_INT
to PME#
Interface
Logic
EN_SMI_PME
Bit 6 of
SMI_EN2 Register
EN_RING
nRING
EVENT
PINT
U2INT
U1INT
FINT
GPINT1
WDT
MINT
KINT
IRINT
BINT
P12
GPINT2
GPINT2
SLP_CTRL
Bit 0 of the Sleep Enable
Configuration Register
0xF0 of Logical Device A.
SLP_EN_SMI
SLP_EN
Interrupt Status bit: Cleared by
a read of register
Sticky Status bit: Cleared by a
write of `1' to this bit
RING Bit, PME_STS1 Register
158
CONFIGURATION
The Configuration of the FDC37B72x is very
flexible and is based on the configuration
architecture implemented in typical Plug-and-
Play components. The FDC37B72x is designed
for motherboard applications in which the
resources required by their components are
known. With its flexible resource allocation
architecture, the FDC37B72x allows the BIOS to
assign resources at POST.
SYSTEM ELEMENTS
Primary Configuration Address Decoder
After a hard reset (RESET_DRV pin asserted) or
Vcc Power On Reset the FDC37B72x is in the
Run Mode with all logical devices disabled. The
logical devices may be configured through two
standard Configuration I/O Ports (INDEX and
DATA) by placing the FDC37B72x into
Configuration Mode. The BIOS uses these
configuration ports to initialize the logical
devices at POST. The INDEX and DATA ports
are only valid when the FDC37B72x is in
Configuration Mode.
The SYSOPT pin is latched on the falling edge
of the RESET_DRV or on Vcc Power On Reset
to determine the configuration register's base
address. The SYSOPT pin is used to select the
CONFIG PORT's I/O address at power-up.
Once powered up the configuration port base
address can be changed through configuration
registers CR26 and CR27. The SYSOPT pin
is a hardware configuration pin which is
shared with the nRTS1 signal on pin 115.
During reset this pin is a weak active low signal
which sinks 30µA. Note: All I/O addresses are
qualified with AEN.
The INDEX and DATA ports are effective only
when the chip is in the Configuration State.
PORT NAME
SYSOPT= 0
(Pull-down resistor)
Refer to Note 1
SYSOPT= 1
(10K Pull-up resistor)
TYPE
CONFIG PORT (Note 2)
0x03F0
0x0370
Write
INDEX PORT (Note 2)
0x03F0
0x0370
Read/Write
DATA PORT
INDEX PORT + 1
Read/Write
Note 1: If using TTL RS232 drivers use 1K pull-down. If using CMOS RS232 drivers use 10K pull-
down.
Note 2: The configuration port base address can be relocated through CR26 and CR27.
Entering the Configuration State
The device enters the Configuration State when
the following Config Key is successfully written
to the CONFIG PORT.
Config Key = < 0x55>
When in configuration mode, all logical devices
function properly. Entering and exiting
configuration mode has no effect on the devices.
Exiting the Configuration State
The device exits the Configuration State when
the following Config Key is successfully written
to the CONFIG PORT.
Config Key = < 0xAA>
159
CONFIGURATION SEQUENCE
To program the configuration registers, the
following sequence must be followed:
1. Enter Configuration Mode
2. Configure the Configuration Registers
3. Exit Configuration Mode.
Enter Configuration Mode
To place the chip into the Configuration State
the Config Key is sent to the chip's CONFIG
PORT. The config key consists of a write of
0x55 data to the CONFIG PORT. Once the
initiation key is received correctly the chip enters
into the Configuration State (The auto Config
ports are enabled).
Configuration Mode
The system sets the logical device information
and activates desired logical devices through
the INDEX and DATA ports. In configuration
mode, the INDEX PORT is located at the
CONFIG PORT address and the DATA PORT is
at INDEX PORT address + 1.
The desired configuration registers are accessed
in two steps:
a. Write the index of the Logical Device
Number Configuration Register (i.e., 0x07) to
the INDEX PORT and then write the number
of the desired logical device to the DATA
PORT
b. Write the address of the desired
configuration register within the logical
device to the INDEX PORT and then write or
read the configuration register through the
DATA PORT.
Note: if accessing the Global Configuration
Registers, step (a) is not required.
Exit Configuration Mode
To exit the Configuration State the system writes
0xAA to the CONFIG PORT. The chip returns
to the RUN State.
Note: Only two states are defined (Run and
Configuration). In the Run State the chip will
always be ready to enter the Configuration
State.
160
Programming Example
The following is an example of a configuration program in Intel 8086 assembly language.
;--------------------------------------------------.
; ENTER CONFIGURATION MODE |
;--------------------------------------------------'
MOVDX,3F0H
MOVAX,055H
CLI ; disable interrupts
OUTDX,AL
STI ; enable interrupts
;--------------------------------------------------.
; CONFIGURE REGISTER CRE0, |
; LOGICAL DEVICE 8 |
;--------------------------------------------------'
MOVDX,3F0H
MOVAL,07H
OUTDX,AL ; Point to LD# Config Reg
MOVDX,3F1H
MOVAL, 08H
OUTDX,AL ; Point to Logical Device 8
;
MOVDX,3F0H
MOVAL,E0H
OUTDX,AL; Point to CRE0
MOVDX,3F1H
MOVAL,02H
OUTDX,AL; Update CRE0
;-------------------------------------------------.
; EXIT CONFIGURATION MODE |
;-------------------------------------------------'
MOVDX,3F0H
MOVAX,0AAH
OUTDX,AL
Notes: 1. HARD RESET: RESET_DRV pin asserted
2. SOFT RESET: Bit 0 of Configuration Control register set to one
3. All host accesses are blocked for 500µs after Vcc POR (see Power-up Timing Diagram)
161
CONFIGURATION REGISTERS
INDEX
TYPE
HARD
RESET
Vcc POR
Vtr POR
Vbat
POR
SOFT
RESET
CONFIGURATION
REGISTER
GLOBAL CONFIGURATION REGISTERS
0x02
W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
Config Control
0x03
R/W
0x03
0x03
0x03
-
-
Index Address
0x07
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Logical Device Number
0x20
R
0x4C
0x4C
0x4C
-
0x4C
Device ID - hard wired
0x21
R
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Device Rev - hard wired
0x22
R/W
0x00
(Note 0)
0x00
(Note 0)
0x00
(Note 0)
-
0x00
(Note 0)
Power Control
0x23
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
Power Mgmt
0x24
R/W
0x04
0x04
0x04
-
-
OSC
0x26
R/W
Sysopt=0:
0xF0
Sysopt=1:
0x70
Sysopt=0:
0xF0
Sysopt=1:
0x70
-
-
-
Configuration Port Address
Byte 0
0x27
R/W
Sysopt=0:
0x03
Sysopt=1:
0x03
Sysopt=0:
0x03
Sysopt=1:
0x03
-
-
-
Configuration Port Address
Byte 1
0x28
R/W
0x00
0x00
-
-
0x00
Clock Mask Register
0x2B
R/W
-
0x00
0x00
-
-
TEST 4
0x2C
R/W
-
0x00
0x00
-
-
TEST 5
0x2D
R/W
-
0x00
0x00
-
-
TEST 1
0x2E
R/W
-
0x00
0x00
-
-
TEST 2
0x2F
R/W
-
0x00
0x00
-
-
TEST 3
LOGICAL DEVICE 0 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (FDD)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
0x60,
0x61
R/W
0x03,
0xF0
0x03,
0xF0
0x03,
0xF0
-
0x03,
0xF0
Primary Base I/O Address
0x70
R/W
0x06
0x06
0x06
-
0x06
Primary Interrupt Select
0x74
R/W
0x02
0x02
0x02
-
0x02
DMA Channel Select
0xF0
R/W
0x0E
0x0E
0x0E
-
-
FDD Mode Register
0xF1
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
FDD Option Register
0xF2
R/W
0xFF
0xFF
0xFF
-
-
FDD Type Register
0xF4
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
FDD0
0xF5
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
FDD1
LOGICAL DEVICE 1 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Reserved)
162
INDEX
TYPE
HARD
RESET
Vcc POR
Vtr POR
Vbat
POR
SOFT
RESET
CONFIGURATION
REGISTER
LOGICAL DEVICE 2 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Reserved)
LOGICAL DEVICE 3 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Parallel Port)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
0x60,
0x61
R/W
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
-
0x00,
0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x70
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0x74
R/W
0x04
0x04
0x04
-
0x04
DMA Channel Select
0xF0
R/W
0x3C
0x3C
0x3C
-
-
Parallel Port Mode Register
0xF1
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
Parallel Port Mode Register 2
LOGICAL DEVICE 4 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Serial Port 1)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
0x60,
0x61
R/W
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
-
0x00,
0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x70
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0xF0
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
Serial Port 1 Mode Register
LOGICAL DEVICE 5 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Serial Port 2)
0x30
R/W
-
-
0x00
-
-
Activate
0x60,
0x61
R/W
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
-
0x00,
0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x70
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0xF0
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
Serial Port 2 Mode Register
0xF1
R/W
0x02
0x02
0x02
-
-
IR Options Register
0xF2
R/W
0x03
0x03
0x03
-
-
IR Half Duplex Timeout
LOGICAL DEVICE 6 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Reserved)
LOGICAL DEVICE 7 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Keyboard)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
0x70
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0x72
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Second Interrupt Select
0xF0
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
KRESET and GateA20
Select
LOGICAL DEVICE 8 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Aux I/O)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
0xB0
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Soft Power Enable Register 1
3
0xB1
R/W
-
-
-
0x80
-
Soft Power Enable Register 2
3
163
INDEX
TYPE
HARD
RESET
Vcc POR
Vtr POR
Vbat
POR
SOFT
RESET
CONFIGURATION
REGISTER
0xB2
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Soft Power Status Register 1
3
0xB3
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Soft Power Status Register 2
3
0xB8
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Delay 2 Time Set Register
0xC0
R/W
0x00
0x00
-
-
-
IRQ Mux Control
3
0xC1
R/W
0x01
0x01
-
-
-
Force Disk Change
0xC2
R
-
-
-
-
-
Floppy Data Rate Select
Shadow
0xC3
R
-
-
-
-
-
UART1 FIFO Control
Shadow
0xC4
R
-
-
-
-
-
UART2 FIFO Control
Shadow
0xC5
R/W
0x00
0x00
-
-
-
FDC Forced Write Protect
0xC6
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Ring Filter Select
3
0xC8
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP50
3
0xCA
R/W
-
-
-
0x09
-
GP52
3
0xCB
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP53
3
0xCC
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP54
3
0xD0
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP60
3
0xD1
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP61
3
0xD2
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP62
3
0xD3
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP63
3
0xD4
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP64
3
0xD5
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP65
3
0xD6
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP66
3
0xD7
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP67
3
0xE0
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP10
3
0xE1
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP11
3
0xE2
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP12
3
0xE3
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP13
3
0xE4
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP14
3
0xE5
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP15
3
0xE6
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP16
3
0xE7
R/W
-
-
-
0x01
-
GP17
3
0xEF
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
GP_INT2
3
0xF0
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
GP_INT1
3
0xF1
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
WDT_UNITS
164
INDEX
TYPE
HARD
RESET
Vcc POR
Vtr POR
Vbat
POR
SOFT
RESET
CONFIGURATION
REGISTER
0xF2
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
WDT_VAL
0xF3
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
-
WDT_CFG
0xF4
R/W
(1)
Note 5
Note 5
0x00
-
-
WDT_CTRL
0xF6
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
GP1
3
0xF9
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
GP5
3
0xFA
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
GP6
3
LOGICAL DEVICE A CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (ACPI)
0x30
R/W
0x00
0x00
0x00
-
0x00
Activate
4
0x60,
0x61
(2)
R/W
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
0x00,
0x00
-
0x00,
0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
PM1_BLK
0x70
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Primary Interrupt Select
3
0xF0
R/W
-
-
-
0x00
-
Sleep/Wake Configuration
3
Notes
Note 0: CR22 Bit 5 is reset on Vtr POR only
Note 1: This register contains some bits which are read or write only.
Note 2: Register 60 is the high byte; 61 is the low byte. For example to set the primary base address
to 1234h, write 12h into 60, and 34h into 61.
Note 3: These configuration registers are powered by Vtr and battery backed up.
Note 4: The Activate bit for Logical Device A does not effect the generation of an interrupt (SCI).
Note 5: Bits[0,2-7] are cleared on a Vc
C
POR or RESET_DRV.
165
Chip Level (Global) Control/Configuration Registers [0x00-0x2F]
The chip-level (global) registers lie in the address range [0x00-0x2F]. The design MUST use all 8 bits
of the ADDRESS Port for register selection. All unimplemented registers and bits ignore writes and
return zero when read.
The INDEX PORT is used to select a configuration register in the chip. The DATA PORT is then used
to access the selected register. These registers are accessible only in the Configuration Mode.
TABLE 63 - CHIP LEVEL REGISTERS
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
Chip (Global) Control Registers
0x00 -
0x01
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Config Control
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x02 W
The hardware automatically clears this bit after the write,
there is no need for software to clear the bits.
Bit 0 = 1: Soft Reset. Refer to the "Configuration
Registers" table for the soft reset value for each register.
C
Index Address
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x03 R/W
Bit[7]
= 1
Enable GP1, WDT_CTRL, GP5, GP6, Soft
Power Enable and Status Register access when
not in configuration mode
= 0
Disable GP1, WDT_CTRL, GP5, GP6, Soft
Power Enable and Status Register access when
not in configuration mode (Default)
Bits [6:2]
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Bits[1:0]
Sets GP1 etc. selection register used when in Run mode
(not in Configuration Mode).
= 11
0xEA (Default)
= 10
0xE4
= 01
0xE2
= 00
0xE0
0x04 - 0x06
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Logical Device #
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x07 R/W
A write to this register selects the current logical device.
This allows access to the control and configuration
registers for each logical device. Note: the Activate
command operates only on the selected logical device.
C
166
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
Card Level
Reserved
0x08 - 0x1F
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Chip Level, SMSC Defined
Device ID
Hard wired
= 0x4C
0x20 R
A read only register which provides device identification.
Bits[7:0] = 0x4C when read
C
Device Rev
Hard wired
= 0x00
0x21 R
A read only register which provides device revision
information. Bits[7:0] = 0x00 when read
C
PowerControl
Default = 0x00.
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
hardware signal.
0x22 R/W
Bit[0] FDC Power
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[3] Parallel Port Power
Bit[4] Serial Port 1 Power
Bit[5] Serial Port 2 Power
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Reserved
= 0
Power off or disabled
= 1
Power on or enabled
C
Power Mgmt
Default = 0x00.
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
hardware signal
0x23 R/W
Bit[0] FDC
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[3] Parallel Port
Bit[4] Serial Port 1
Bit[5] Serial Port 2
Bit[6] Reserved (read as 0)
Bit[7] Reserved (read as 0)
= 0
Intelligent Pwr Mgmt off
= 1
Intelligent Pwr Mgmt on
C
167
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
OSC
Default = 0x04,
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
hardware signal.
0x24 R/W
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit [1] PLL Control
= 0
PLL is on (backward Compatible)
= 1
PLL is off
Bits[3:2] OSC
= 01
Osc is on, BRG clock is on.
= 10
Same as above (01) case.
= 00
Osc is on, BRG Clock Enabled.
= 11
Osc is off, BRG clock is disabled.
Bit [6:4] Reserved, set to zero
Bit[7] IRQ8 Polarity
= 0
IRQ8 is active high
= 1 IRQ8 is active low
C
Chip Level
Vendor Defined
0x25
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Configuration
Address Byte 0
Default=0xF0
(Sysopt=0)
=0x70
(Sysopt=1)
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x26
Bit[7:1] Configuration Address Bits [7:1]
Bit[0] = 0
See Note 1 Below
C
Configuration
Address Byte 1
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x27
Bit[7:0] Configuration Address Bits [15:8]
See Note 1 Below
C
Chip Level
Vendor Defined
0x28 -0x2A
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
TEST 4
0x2B R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
TEST 5
0x2C R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
TEST 1
0x2D R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
TEST 2
0x2E R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
168
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
TEST 3
Default = 0x00,
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
hardware signal.
0x2F R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
Note 1: To allow the selection of the configuration address to a user defined location, these
Configuration Address Bytes are used. There is no restriction on the address chosen, except
that A0 is 0, that is, the address must be on an even byte boundary. As soon as both bytes
are changed, the configuration space is moved to the specified location with no delay (Note:
Write byte 0, then byte 1; writing CR27 changes the base address).
The configuration address is only reset to its default address upon a Hard Reset or Vcc POR.
Note: The default configuration address is either 3F0 or 370, as specified by the SYSOPT pin.
This change affects SMSC Mode only.
169
Logical Device Configuration/Control
Registers [0x30-0xFF]
Used to access the registers that are assigned
to each logical unit. This chip supports seven
logical units and has seven sets of logical
device registers. The logical devices are
Floppy, Parallel Port, Serial Port 1 and Serial
Port 2, Keyboard Controller, Auxiliary I/O and
ACPI. A separate set (bank) of control and
configuration register exists for each logical
device and is selected with the Logical Device #
Register (0x07).
The INDEX PORT is used to select a specific
logical device register. These registers are then
accessed through the DATA PORT.
The Logical Device registers are accessible only
when the device is in the Configuration State.
The logical register addresses are:
Logical Device Registers
TABLE 64 - LOGICAL DEVICE REGISTERS
LOGICAL DEVICE
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
Activate
Note1
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
Note 2
(0x30)
Bits[7:1] Reserved, set to zero.
Bit[0]
= 1
Activates the logical device currently
selected through the Logical Device #
register.
= 0
Logical device currently selected is
inactive
C
Logical Device
Control
(0x31-0x37)
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
C
Logical Device
Control
(0x38-0x3f)
Vendor Defined - Reserved - Writes are ignored,
reads return 0.
C
Mem Base Addr
(0x40-0x5F)
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
C
I/O Base Addr.
(see Device Base I/O
Address Table)
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
(0x60-0x6F)
0x60,2,... =
addr[15:8]
0x61,3,... =
addr[7:0]
Registers 0x60 and 0x61 set the base address for
the device. If more than one base address is
required, the second base address is set by
registers 0x62 and 0x63.
Refer to - I/O Base Address Configuration
Register Description
- for the number of base
address registers used by each device.
Unused registers will ignore writes and return zero
when read.
C
170
LOGICAL DEVICE
REGISTER
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
Interrupt Select
Defaults :
0x70 = 0x00,
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x72 = 0x00,
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
(0x70,072)
0x70 is implemented for each logical device. Refer
to Interrupt Configuration Register description.
Only the keyboard controller uses Interrupt Select
register 0x72. Unused register (0x72) will ignore
writes and return zero when read. Interrupts
default to edge high (ISA compatible).
C
(0x71,0x73)
Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
DMA Channel Select
Default = 0x04
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
(0x74,0x75)
Only 0x74 is implemented for FDC, Serial Port 2
and Parallel port. 0x75 is not implemented and
ignores writes and returns zero when read. Refer
to DMA Channel Configuration.
C
32-Bit Memory
Space Configuration
(0x76-0xA8) Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
Logical Device
(0xA9-0xDF) Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
C
Logical Device
Config.
(0xE0-0xFE) Reserved - Vendor Defined (see SMSC defined
Logical Device Configuration Registers)
C
Reserved
0xFF
Reserved
C
Note 1: A logical device will be active and powered up according to the following equation:
DEVICE ON (ACTIVE) = (Activate Bit SET or Pwr/Control Bit SET).
The Logical device's Activate Bit and its Pwr/Control Bit are linked such that setting or
clearing one sets or clears the other.
Note:
If the I/O Base Addr of the logical device is not within the Base I/O range as shown in the
Logical Device I/O map, then read or write is not valid and is ignored.
Note 2. The activate bit for Logical Device 5 (Serial Port 2) is reset on Vtr POR only.
171
I/O Base Address Configuration Register
Table 65 - I/O Base Address Configuration Register Description
LOGICAL
DEVICE
NUMBER
LOGICAL
DEVICE
REGISTER
INDEX
BASE I/O
RANGE
(NOTE3)
FIXED
BASE OFFSETS
0x00
FDC
(Note 4)
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
+0 : SRA
+1 : SRB
+2 : DOR
+3 : TSR
+4 : MSR/DSR
+5 : FIFO
+7 : DIR/CCR
0x03
Parallel
Port
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FFC]
ON 4 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
(EPP Not supported)
or
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
(all modes supported,
EPP is only available
when the base
address is on an 8-
byte boundary)
+0 : Data|ecpAfifo
+1 : Status
+2 : Control
+3 : EPP Address
+4 : EPP Data 0
+5 : EPP Data 1
+6 : EPP Data 2
+7 : EPP Data 3
+400h : cfifo|ecpDfifo|tfifo |cnfgA
+401h : cnfgB
+402h : ecr
0x04
Serial Port 1
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
+0 : RB/TB|LSB div
+1 : IER|MSB div
+2 : IIR/FCR
+3 : LCR
+4 : MSR
+5 : LSR
+6 : MSR
+7 : SCR
0x05
Serial Port 2
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
+0 : RB/TB|LSB div
+1 : IER|MSB div
+2 : IIR/FCR
+3 : LCR
+4 : MSR
+5 : LSR
+6 : MSR
+7 : SCR
0x07
KYBD
n/a
Not Relocatable
Fixed Base Address:
60,64
+0 : Data Register
+4 : Command/Status Reg.
0x08
AUX I/O
n/a
Not Relocatable
n/a
172
LOGICAL
DEVICE
NUMBER
LOGICAL
DEVICE
REGISTER
INDEX
BASE I/O
RANGE
(NOTE3)
FIXED
BASE OFFSETS
0x0A
ACPI
0x60,0x61
[0x00:0x0FE7]
ON 24 BYTE
BOUNDARIES
Note 3:This chip uses ISA address bits [A11:A0] to decode the base address of each of its logical
devices.
Interrupt Select Configuration Register
Table 66 - Interrupt Select Configuration Register Description
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Interrupt
Request Level
Select 0
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x70 (R/W)
Bits[3:0] selects which interrupt level is used for
Interrupt 0.
0x00=no interrupt selected.
0x01=IRQ1
0x02=IRQ2
·
·
·
0x0E=IRQ14
0x0F=IRQ15
Note: All interrupts are edge high (except ECP/EPP)
C
Note:
An Interrupt is activated by setting the Interrupt Request Level Select 0 register to a non-zero
value AND :
for the FDC logical device by setting DMAEN, bit D3 of the Digital Output Register.
for the PP logical device by setting IRQE, bit D4 of the Control Port and in addition
for the PP logical device in ECP mode by clearing serviceIntr, bit D2 of the ecr.
for the Serial Port logical device by setting any combination of bits D0-D3 in the IER
and by setting the OUT2 bit in the UART's Modem Control (MCR) Register.
for the KYBD by (refer to the KYBD controller section of this spec.)
Note:IRQ pins must tri-state if not used/selected by any Logical Device. Refer to Note A.
173
DMA Channel Select Configuration Register
Table 67 - DMA Channel Select Configuration Register Description
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
DMA Channel
Select
Default = 0x04
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x74 (R/W)
Bits[2:0] select the DMA Channel.
0x00=DMA0
0x01=DMA1
0x02=DMA2
0x03=DMA3
0x04-0x07= No DMA active
C
Note:
A DMA channel is activated by setting the DMA Channel Select register to [0x00-0x03] AND :
for the FDC logical device by setting DMAEN, bit D3 of the Digital Output Register.
for the PP logical device in ECP mode by setting dmaEn, bit D3 of the ecr.
for the UART 2 logical device, by setting the DMA Enable bit. Refer to the IRCC
specification.
Note:
DMAREQ pins must tri-state if not used/selected by any Logical Device. Refer to Note A.
174
Note A. Logical Device IRQ and DMA Operation
1) IRQ and DMA Enable and Disable: Any time the IRQ or DACK for a logical block is disabled by
a register bit in that logical block, the IRQ and/or DACK must be disabled. This is in addition to
the IRQ and DACK disabled by the Configuration Registers (active bit or address not valid).
2) FDC: For the following cases, the IRQ and DACK used by the FDC are disabled (high
impedance). Will not respond to the DREQ
(a)
Digital Output Register (Base+2) bit D3 (DMAEN) set to "0".
(b)
The FDC is in power down (disabled).
3) Serial Port 1 and 2: Modem Control Register (MCR) Bit D2 (OUT2) - When OUT2 is a logic "0",
the serial port interrupt is forced to a high impedance state - disabled.
4) Parallel Port: SPP and EPP modes: Control Port (Base+2) bit D4 (IRQE) set to "0", IRQ is
disabled (high impedance).
1) ECP Mode:
(a)
(DMA) dmaEn from ecr register. See table.
(b)
IRQ - See table.
MODE
(FROM ECR REGISTER)
IRQ PIN
CONTROLLED BY
PDREQ PIN
CONTROLLED BY
000
PRINTER
IRQE
dmaEn
001
SPP
IRQE
dmaEn
010
FIFO
(on)
dmaEn
011
ECP
(on)
dmaEn
100
EPP
IRQE
dmaEn
101
RES
IRQE
dmaEn
110
TEST
(on)
dmaEn
111
CONFIG
IRQE
dmaEn
1) Keyboard Controller: Refer to the KBD section of this spec.
175
SMSC Defined Logical Device Configuration Registers
The SMSC Specific Logical Device Configuration Registers reset to their default values only on hard
resets generated by Vcc POR or VTR POR or VBAT POR (as shown) or the RESET_DRV signal.
These registers are not affected by soft resets.
Table 68 - Floppy Disk Controller, Logical Device 0 [Logical Device Number = 0x00]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
FDD Mode Register
Default = 0x0E
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF0 R/W
Bit[0] Floppy Mode
= 0
Normal Floppy Mode (default)
= 1
Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 (OS2)
Bit[1] FDC DMA Mode
= 0
Burst Mode is enabled
= 1
Non-Burst Mode (default)
Bit[3:2] Interface Mode
= 11
AT Mode (default)
= 10
(Reserved)
= 01
PS/2
= 00
Model 30
Bit[4] Swap Drives 0,1 Mode
= 0
No swap (default)
= 1
Drive and Motor sel 0 and 1 are swapped.
Bits[5] Reserved, set to zero.
Bit [6] Output Type Control:
0= FDC outputs are OD24 open drain (default)
1= FDC outputs are O24 push-pull.
Bit [7] FDC output Control:
0= FDC outputs active (default)
1= FDC outputs tristated
Note: these bits do not affect the parallel port FDC
pins.
C
FDD Option
Register
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1 R/W
Bits[1:0] Reserved, set to zero
Bits[3:2] Density Select
= 00
Normal (default)
= 01
Normal (reserved for users)
= 10
1 (forced to logic "1")
= 11
0 (forced to logic "0")
Bit[5:4] Reserved, set to zero
Bits[7:6] Boot Floppy
= 00
FDD 0 (default)
= 01
FDD 1
= 10
Reserved (neither drive A or B is a boot
drive).
= 11
Reserved (neither drive A or B is a boot
drive).
C
176
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
FDD Type Register
Default = 0xFF
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF2 R/W
Bits[1:0] Floppy Drive A Type
Bits[3:2] Floppy Drive B Type
Bits[5:4] Reserved (could be used to store Floppy
Drive C type)
Bits[7:6] Reserved (could be used to store Floppy
Drive D type)
Note: The FDC37B72x supports
two floppy drives
C
0xF3 R
Reserved, Read as 0 (read only)
C
FDD0
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF4 R/W
Bits[1:0] Drive Type Select: DT1, DT0
Bits[2] Read as 0 (read only)
Bits[4:3] Data Rate Table Select: DRT1, DRT0
Bits[5] Read as 0 (read only)
Bits[6] Precompensation Disable PTS
=0 Use Precompensation
=1 No Precompensation
Bits[7] Read as 0 (read only)
C
FDD1
0xF5 R/W
Refer to definition and default for 0xF4
C
177
Parallel Port, Logical Device 3
Table 69 - Parallel Port, Logical Device 3 [Logical Device Number = 0x03]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
PP Mode Register
Default = 0x3C
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF0 R/W
Bits[2:0] Parallel Port Mode
= 100
Printer Mode (default)
= 000
Standard and Bi-directional (SPP) Mode
= 001
EPP-1.9 and SPP Mode
= 101
EPP-1.7 and SPP Mode
= 010
ECP Mode
= 011
ECP and EPP-1.9 Mode
= 111
ECP and EPP-1.7 Mode
Bit[6:3] ECP FIFO Threshold
0111b (default)
Bit[7] PP Interrupt Type
Not valid when the parallel port is in the Printer
Mode (100) or the Standard & Bi-directional Mode
(000).
= 1
Pulsed Low, released to high-Z.
= 0
IRQ follows nACK when parallel port in EPP
Mode or [Printer,SPP, EPP] under ECP.
IRQ level type when the parallel port is in ECP,
TEST, or Centronics FIFO Mode.
C
PP Mode Register
2
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1 R/W
Bits[1:0] PPFDC - muxed PP/FDC control
= 00 Normal Parallel Port Mode
= 01 PPFD1:
Drive 0 is on the FDC pins
Drive 1 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 2 is on the FDC pins
Drive 3 is on the FDC pins
= 10 PPFD2:
Drive 0 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 1 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 2 is on the FDC pins
Drive 3 is on the FDC pins
Bits[7:2] Reserved. Set to zero.
178
Serial Port 1, Logical Device 4
Table 70 - Serial Port 1, Logical Device 4 [Logical Device Number = 0x04]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Serial Port 1
Mode Register
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF0 R/W
Bit[0] MIDI Mode
= 0
MIDI support disabled (default)
= 1
MIDI support enabled
Bit[1] High Speed
= 0
High Speed Disabled(default)
= 1
High Speed Enabled
Bit[6:2] Reserved, set to zero
Bit[7]: Share IRQ
=0 UARTS use different IRQs
=1 UARTS share a common IRQ
See Note 1 below.
C
Note 1: To properly share and IRQ,
1. Configure UART1 (or UART2) to use the desired IRQ pin.
2. Configure UART2 (or UART1) to use No IRQ selected.
3. Set the share IRQ bit.
Note: If both UARTs are configured to use different IRQ pins and the share IRQ bit is set, then both of
the UART IRQ pins will assert when either UART generates an interrupt.
179
Serial Port 2, Logical Device 5
Table 71 - Serial Port 2, Logical Device 5 [Logical Device Number = 0x05]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Serial Port 2
Mode Register
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF0 R/W
Bit[0] MIDI Mode
= 0
MIDI support disabled (default)
= 1
MIDI support enabled
Bit[1] High Speed
= 0
High Speed disabled(default)
= 1
High Speed enabled
Bit[7:2] Reserved, set to zero
C
IR Option Register
Default = 0x02
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1 R/W
Bit[0] Receive Polarity
= 0
Active High (Default)
= 1
Active Low
Bit[1] Transmit Polarity
= 0
Active High
= 1
Active Low (Default)
Bit[2] Duplex Select
= 0
Full Duplex (Default)
= 1
Half Duplex
Bits[5:3] IR Mode
= 000
Standard (Default)
= 001
IrDA
= 010
ASK-IR
= 011
Reserved
= 1xx
Reserved
Bit[6] IR Location Mux
= 0
Use Serial port TXD2 and RXD2 (Default)
= 1
Use alternate IRRX2 (pin 81) and IRTX2
(pin 82)
Bit[7] Reserved, write 0
C
IR Half Duplex
Timeout
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF2
Bits [7:0]
These bits set the half duplex time-out for the IR
port. This value is 0 to 10msec in 100usec
increments.
0= blank during transmit/receive
1= blank during transmit/receive + 100usec
. . .
180
KYBD, Logical Device 7
Table 72 - KYBD, Logical Device 7 [Logical Device Number = 0x07]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
KRST_GA20
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF0
R/W
KRESET and GateA20 Select
Bit[7] Polarity Select for P12
= 0 P12 active low (default)
= 1 P12 active high
Bits[6:3] Reserved
Bit[2] Port 92 Select
= 0 Port 92 Disabled
= 1 Port 92 Enabled
Bit[1] GATEA20 Select
= 0 Software Control
= 1 Hardware Speed-up
Bit[0] KRESET Select
= 0 Software Control
= 1 Hardware Speed-up
0xF1 -
0xFF
Reserved - read as `0'
181
Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8
Table 73 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08]
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Soft Power Enable
Register 1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xB0 R/W
The following bits are the enables for the wake-up
function of the nPowerOn bit. When enabled,
these bits allow their corresponding function to
turn on power to the system.
1 = ENABLED
0 = DISABLED
Bit[0] SP_RI1: UART 1 Ring Indicator Pin
Bit[1] SP_RI2: UART 2 Ring Indicator Pin
Bit[2] SP_KDAT: Keyboard Data Pin
Bit[3] SP_MDAT: Mouse Data Pin
Bit[4] SP_GPINT1: Group Interrupt 1
Bit[5] SP_GPINT2: Group Interrupt 2
Bit[6] SP_IRRX2: IRRX2 Input Pin
Bit[7] Reserved
C
182
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Soft Power Enable
Register 2
Default = 0x80
on Vbat POR
0xB1 R/W
The following bits are the enables for the wake-up
function of the nPowerOn bit. When enabled,
these bits allow their corresponding function to
turn on power to the system.
1 = ENABLED
0 = DISABLED
Bit[0] SP_RXD1: UART 1 Receive Data Pin
Bit[1] SP_RXD2: UART 2 Receive Data Pin
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[3] RING Enable bit "RING_EN"
1=Enable ring indicator on nRING pin as wakeup
function to activate nPowerOn.
0=Disable.
Bit[4] VTR_POR_OFF. Controls state of
nPowerOn after VTR POR.
1=the nPowerOn pin will go inactive (float) and the
machine will remain off when the VTR POR
occurs. Software must not set VTR_POR_OFF
and VTR_POR_EN at the same time.
0=the nPowerOn pin will remain in the state it was
in prior to the VTR POR (unless the
VTR_POR_EN bit is set).
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] VTR_POR_EN. Controls state of nPowerOn
after VTR POR.
1= the nPowerOn pin will go active (low) and the
machine will power-up as soon as a VTR POR
occurs. Software must not set VTR_POR_OFF
and VTR_POR_EN at the same time.
0=the nPowerOn pin will remain in the state it was
in prior to the VTR POR (unless the
VTR_POR_OFF bit is set).
Bit[7] OFF_EN: After power up, this bit defaults to
1, i.e., enabled. This bit allows the software to
enable or disable the button control of power off.
C
183
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Soft Power Status
Register 1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xB2 R/W
The following bits are the status for the wake-up
function of the nPowerOn bit. These indicate
which of the enabled wakeup functions caused the
power up.
1 = Occurred
0 = Did not occur since last cleared
The following signals are latched to detect and
hold the soft power event (Type 1) (Note 1)
Bit[0] RI1: UART 1 Ring Indicator; high to low
transition on the pin, cleared by a read of
this register
Bit[1] RI2: UART 2 Ring Indicator; high to low
transition on the pin, cleared by a read of
this register
Bit[2] KDAT: Keyboard data; high to low transition
on the pin, cleared by a read of this
register
Bit[3] MDAT: Mouse data; high to low transition on
the pin, cleared by a read of this register
Bit[6] IRRX2: IRRX2 input; high to low transition
on the pin, cleared by a read of this
register
Bit[7] Reserved
The following signals are not latched to detect and
hold the soft power event (Type 2) (Note 1)
Bit[4] GPINT1: Group Interrupt 1; status of the
GPINT1 internal signal. Cleared at the
source
Bit[5] GPINT2: Group Interrupt 2; status of the
GPINT2 internal signal. Cleared at the
source
C
184
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Soft Power Status
Register 2
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xB3 R/W
The following bits are the status for the wake-up
function of the nPowerOn bit. These indicate
which of the enabled wakeup functions caused the
power up.
1 = Occurred
0 = Did not occur since last cleared
The following signals are latched to detect and
hold the soft power event (Type 1) (Note 1)
Bit[0] RXD1: UART 1 Receive Data; high to low
transition on the pin, cleared by a read of
this register
Bit[1] RXD2: UART 2 Receive Data; high to low
transition on the pin, cleared by a read of
this register
Bit[3] RING Status bit "RING_STS"; Latched,
cleared on read.
0= nRING input did not occur.
1= Ring indicator input occurred on the nRING pin
and, if enabled, caused the wakeup
(activated nPowerOn)
Bit[5:4] Reserved
The following signal is latched to detect and hold
the soft power event (Type 3) (Note 1) but the
output of the latch does not feed into the power
down circuitry:
Bit[2] Button: Button pressed, Cleared by a read of
this register
Bits[7:6] Reserved
C
185
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Delay 2 Time Set
Register
Default = 0x00
on VTR POR
0xB8 R/W
This register is used to set Delay 2 (for Soft Power
Management) to a value from 500 msec to 32 sec.
The default value is 500msec. Engineering Note:
this delay is started if OFF_EN is enabled and
OFF_DLY was set and a Button Input comes in.
Bits[5:0] The value of these bits correspond to the
delay time as follows:
000000= 500msec min to 510msec max
000001= 1sec min to 1.01sec max
000010= 1.5sec min to 1.51sec max
000011= 2sec min to 2.01sec max
...
111111 = 32sec min to 32.01sec max
Bits[7:6] Reserved
C
186
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
IRQ Mux Control
Register
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0XC0 R/W
This register is used to configure the IRQs,
including PME, SCI and SMI.
Bit[0] Serial/Parallel IRQs
0=Serial IRQs are used
1=Parallel IRQS are used
Note 1: This bit does not control the SCI or SMI
interrupts. See bits 2,7 of this register.
Note 2: If set, the BIOS buffer is disabled. Also,
the SER_IRQ and PCI_CLK pins are
disabled, and these pins function as IRQ15
and IRQ14, respectively.
Note 3: Select IRQ9 below. Select SCI below.
Select nSMI through the SMI register.
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] SCI Select
0=SCI is on serial IRQ frame
1=SCI is on IRQx pin
Bit[3] SCI Polarity Select (EN1)
0=SCI active low
1=SCI active high
Bit[4] SCI Buffer Type (EN1)
0=Push-pull
1=Open drain
Bit[6:5] SCI/PME/IRQ9 Pin select
00=Pin 21 is used for nPME signal.
01=Pin 21 is used for SCI.
10=Pin 21 is used for IRQ9.
11=Reserved
Note: If bit 5 is set, this overrides the setting of the
IRQ for SCI in Config Register 0x70 of Logical
Device A. See the logic in the SCI section.
g Note: This bit selects the buffer type of the pin as
follows: if nPMEis selected, it is active low OD; if
SCI is selected, the buffer type and polarity are
selected through bits 3 and 4 of this register; if
IRQ9 is selected, it is an active high push-pull
output.
Bit[7] SMI Select
0=SMI is on serial IRQ frame (IRQ2)
1=SMI is on nSMI pin
Engineering Note: the polarity and buffer type of
the SMI pin is selected through the GPIO registers
(default is active low open drain).
187
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Forced Disk
Change
Default = 0x03
on VTR POR
0xC1 R/W
Force Change 1 and Force Change 0 can be
written to 1 are not clearable by software.
Force Change 1 is cleared on (nSTEP AND nDS1)
Force Change 0 is cleared on (nSTEP AND
nDS0).
DSK CHG (Floppy DIR Register, Bit 7) = (nDS0
AND Force Change 0) OR (nDS1 AND Force
Change 1) OR nDSKCHG.
Setting either of the Force Disk Change bits active
(1) forces the FDD nDSKCHG input active when
the appropriate drive has been selected.
Bit[0] Force Change for FDC0
0=Inactive
1=Active
Bit[1] Force Change for FDC1
0=Inactive
1=Active
Bit[2:7] Reserved, Reads 0
Floppy Data Rate
Select Shadow
0xC2 R
Floppy Data Rate Select Shadow Register
Bit[7] Soft Reset
Bit[6] Power Down
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[4] PRECOMP 2
Bit[3] PRECOMP 1
Bit[2] PRECOMP 0
Bit[1] Data Rate Select 1
Bit[0] Data Rate Select 0
UART1 FIFO
Control Shadow
0xC3 R
UART1 FIFO Control Shadow Register
Bit[7] RCVR Trigger MSB
Bit[6] RCVR Trigger LSB
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[4] Reserved
Bit[3] DMA Mode Select
Bit[2] XMIT FIFO Reset
Bit[1] RCVR FIFO Reset
Bit[0] FIFO Enable
UART2 FIFO
Control Shadow
0xC4 R
UART2 FIFO Control Shadow Register
Bit[7] RCVR Trigger MSB
Bit[6] RCVR Trigger LSB
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[4] Reserved
Bit[3] DMA Mode Select
Bit[2] XMIT FIFO Reset
Bit[1] RCVR FIFO Reset
Bit[0] FIFO Enable
188
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Forced Write
Protect
Default = 0x00
on VTR POR
0xC5 R/W
Force Write Protect function forces the FDD
nWRTPRT input active if the FORCE WRTPRT bit
is active. The Force Write Protect function applies
to the nWRTPRT pin in the FDD Interface as well
as the nWRTPRT pin in the Parallel Port FDC.
Bit[0] Force Write Protect bit FDD0
0 = Inactive (Default)
1 = Active "forces the FDD nWRTPRT input active
when the drive has been selected" Note 2
Bit[1:7] Reserved, reads 0.
189
NAME
REG
INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Ring Filter Select
Register
Default = 0x00 on
Vbat POR
Note 3
0xC6 R/W
This register is used to select the operation of the
ring indicator on the nRI1, nRI2 and nRING pins.
It also contains bits to select crystal load
capacitance and P17/P12 function.
Bit[0]: 1=Enable detection of pulse train of
frequency 15Hz or higher for 200msec and
generate an active low pulse for its duration to use
as the ring indicator function on nRING pin. The
leading high-to-low edge is the trigger for the ring
indication.
0=Ring indicate function is high-to-low transition
on the nRING pin.
Bit[1]: 1=Enable detection of pulse train of
frequency 15Hz or higher and generate an active
low pulse for its duration to use for 200msec as
the ring indicator function on nRI1 pin. The
leading high-to-low edge is the trigger for the ring
indication.
0=Ring indicate function is high-to-low transition
on the nRI1 pin.
Bit[2]: 1=Enable detection of pulse train of
frequency 15Hz or higher and generate an active
low pulse for its duration to use for 200msec as
the ring indicator function on nRI2 pin. The
leading high-to-low edge is the trigger for the ring
indication.
0=Ring indicate function is high-to-low transition
on the nRI2 pin.
Bit[5:3] Reserved
Bit[6] XTAL CAP. This bit is used to specify the
load capacitance of the 32kHz XTAL: 0=12pF
(Default), 1=6pF.
Bit[7] P17/P12. 0=the function of P17/P12 on
GP12 (pin 79) and GP64 (pin 87) is P17. (Default)
1=the function of P17/P12 on GP12 (pin 79) and
GP64 (pin 87) is P12 and the keylock function is
not active.
C
190
Table 74 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP10
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE0
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.0
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1 nSMI
=0
GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
GP11
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE1
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.1
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 GPI/O
=01 nRING
=10
Either Edge Triggered Interrupt 1
=11
Reserved
Bits[6:5] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
191
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP12
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE2
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.2
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity :=1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 GPI/O
=01 WDT
=10 P17/P12
1
=11
Either Edge Triggered Interupt 2
Bits[6:5] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
Note 1: This function is selected via bit 7 of the Ring
Filter Select Register. Default is P17.
C
GP13
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE3
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.3
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1
LED
=0
GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
GP14
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE4
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.4
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1
IRRX2
=0
GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
192
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP15
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE5
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.5
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1 IRTX2
=0 GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
GP16
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE6
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.6
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1 nMTR1
=0 GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
GP17
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xE7
General Purpose I/0 bit 1.7
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 1
=0
Disable Combined IRQ 1
Bit[3] Function Select
=1 nDS1
=0 GPI/O
Bits[6:4] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
C
193
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP50
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xC8
General Purpose I/0 bit 5.0
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 PCI Clock
=01 IRQ14
=10 GPI/O
=11 Reserved
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP52
Default =0x09
on Vbat POR
0xCA
General Purpose I/0 bit 5.2
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 DRVDEN1
=01 GPIO
=10 IRQ8
=11 nSMI
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
194
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP53
Default =0x01
on Vbat POR
0xCB
General Purpose I/0 bit 5.3
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 nROMCS
=01 IRQ11
=10 GPI/O
=11 Either Edge Triggered Interrupt 3
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP54
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xCC
General Purpose I/0 bit 5.4
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 nROMOE
=01 IRQ12
=10 GPI/O
=11 Either Edge Triggered Interrupt 4
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1
Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
195
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP60
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD0
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.0
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD0
=01 IRQ1
=10 GPI/O
=11 nSMI
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP61
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD1
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.1
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD1
=01 IRQ3
=10 GPI/O
=11 LED
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
196
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP62
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD2
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.2
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD2
=01 IRQ4
=10 GPI/O
=11 nRING
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP63
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD3
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.3
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD3
=01 IRQ5
=10 GPI/O
=11 WDT
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
197
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP64
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD4
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.4
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD4
=01 IRQ6
=10 GPI/O
=11 P17/P12
1
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
Note 1: This function is selected via bit 7 of the Ring
Filter Select Register. Default is P17.
GP65
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD5
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.5
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD5
=01 IRQ7
=10 GPI/O
=11 Reserved
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
198
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP66
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD6
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.6
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD6
=01 IRQ8
=10 GPI/O
=11 Reserved
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP67
Default = 0x01
on Vbat POR
0xD7
General Purpose I/0 bit 6.7
Bit[0] In/Out : =1 Input, =0 Output
Bit[1] Polarity : =1 Invert, =0 No Invert
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[4:3] Function Select
=00 RD7
=01 IRQ10
=10 GPI/O
=11 Reserved
Bit[5] Group Interrupt Enable
=1 Enable Combined IRQ 2
=0 Disable Combined IRQ 2
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Output Type Select
1=Open Drain
0=Push Pull
GP_INT2
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xEF
General Purpose I/O Combined Interrupt 2
Bits[2:0] Reserved, = 000
Bit[3] GP IRQ Filter Select
0 =
Debounce Filter Bypassed
1 =
Debounce Filter Enabled
Bits[7:4] Combined IRQ mapping
1111 = IRQ15
.........
0011 = IRQ3
0010 = Invalid
0001 = IRQ1
0000 = Disable
199
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP_INT1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xF0
General Purpose I/O Combined Interrupt 1
Bits[2:0] Reserved, = 000
Bit[3] GP IRQ Filter Select
0 = Debounce Filter Bypassed
1 = Debounce Filter Enabled
Bits[7:4] Combined IRQ mapping
1111 = IRQ15
.........
0011 = IRQ3
0010 = Invalid
0001 = IRQ1
0000 = Disable
C
WDT_UNITS
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1
Watch Dog Timer Units
Bits[6:0] Reserved, = 00000
Bit[7] WDT Time-out Value Units Select
= 0 Minutes (default)
= 1 Seconds
Note: If the logical device's activate bit is not set then
bits 0 and 1 have no effect.
C
WDT_VAL
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF2
Watch-dog Timer Time-out Value
Binary coded, units = minutes(default) or seconds,
selectable via Bit[7] of Reg 0xF1, LD 8.
0x00 Time out disabled
0x01 Time-out = 1 minute/second
.........
0xFF Time-out = 255 minutes/seconds
C
200
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
WDT_CFG
Default = 0x00
On VTR POR Bits
[0,2-7] are also
cleared on V
CC
POR
or RESET_DRV
0xF3
Watch-dog timer Configuration
Bit[0] Joy-stick Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon an I/O read or write of
the Game Port
=0
WDT is not affected by I/O reads or writes
to the Game Port.
Bit[1] Keyboard Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon a Keyboard interrupt.
=0
WDT is not affected by Keyboard interrupts.
Bit[2] Mouse Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon a Mouse interrupt
=0
WDT is not affected by Mouse interrupts.
Bit[3] PWRLED Time-out enable
=1
Enables the Power LED to toggle at a 1Hz
rate with 50 percent duty cycle while the
Watch-dog Status bit is set.
=0
Disables the Power LED toggle during
Watch-dog timeout status.
Bits[7:4] WDT Interrupt Mapping
1111 = IRQ15
.........
0011 = IRQ3
0010 = Invalid
0001 = IRQ1
0000 = Disable
C
201
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
WDT_CTRL
Default = 0x00
Cleared by VTR
POR
0xF4
Watch-dog timer Control
Bit[0] Watch-dog Status Bit, R/W
=1
WD timeout occurred
=0
WD timer counting
Bit[1] Power LED Toggle Enable, R/W
=1
Toggle Power LED at 1Hz rate with 50 percent
duty cycle. (1/2 sec. on, 1/2 sec. off)
=0
Disable Power LED Toggle
Bit[2] Force Timeout, W
=1
Forces WD timeout event; this bit is self-clearing
Bit[3] P20 Force Timeout Enable, R/W
= 1
Allows rising edge of P20, from the Keyboard
Controller, to force the WD timeout event. A
WD timeout event may still be forced by setting
the Force Timeout Bit, bit 2.
= 0
P20 activity does not generate the WD timeout
event.
Note: The P20 signal will remain high for a minimum of 1us
and can remain high indefinitely. Therefore, when P20
forced timeouts are enabled, a self-clearing edge-detect
circuit is used to generate a signal which is ORed with the
signal generated by the Force Timeout Bit.
Bit[4] Reserved. Set to 0.
Bit[5] Stop_Cnt: This is used to terminate Delay 2 (Note 1)
without generating a power down. This is used if
the software determines that the power down
should be aborted. When read, this bit indicates
the following: Stop_Cnt = 0; Counter running
Stop_Cnt = 1; Counter Stopped. Note: The write
is self clearing.
Bit[6] Restart_Cnt: This is used to restart Delay 2 (Note 1)
from the button input to the generation of the
power down. When restarted, the count will
start over and delay the power down for the time
that Delay 2 is set for (Default=500msec). The
software can continue to do this indefinately with
out allowing a powerdown. This bit is self
clearing. 1=Restart; Automatically cleared.
Bit[7] SPOFF: This is used to force a software power
down. This bit is self clearing.
Note 1: This delay is programmable via the Delay 2 Time
Set Register at Logical Device 8, 0xB8.
C
202
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
GP1
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xF6
This register is used to read the value of the GPIO
pins.
Bit[0]: GP10
Bit[1]: GP11
Bit[2]: GP12
Bit[3]: GP13
Bit[4]: GP14
Bit[5]: GP15
Bit[6]: GP16
Bit[7]: GP17
GP5
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xF9
This register is used to read the value of the GPIO
pins.
Bit[0]: GP50
Bit[1]: GP51
Bit[2]: GP52
Bit[3]: GP53
Bit[4]: GP54
Bit[7:5]: Reserved
GP6
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xFA
This register is used to read the value of the GPIO
pins.
Bit[0]: GP60
Bit[1]: GP61
Bit[2]: GP62
Bit[3]: GP63
Bit[4]: GP64
Bit[5]: GP65
Bit[6]: GP66
Bit[7]: GP67
Note:
Registers GP1, WDT_CTRL, GP5-6, Soft Power Enable and Status Registers are also
available at index 01-0F when not in configuration mode.
Note: GP10-17 can be enabled onto GPINT1; GP50-54 and GP60-67 can be enabled onto GPINT2.
203
ACPI, Logical Device A
Table 75 - ACPI, Logical Device A [Logical Device Number = 0x0A]
NAME
REG INDEX
DEFINITION
STATE
Sleep/Wake
Configuration
Default = 0x00
on Vbat POR
0xF0
This register is used to configure the functionality of
the SLP_EN bit and its associated logic, and the
WAK_STS bit bit and its associated logic.
Bit[0] SLP_CTRL. SLP_EN Bit Function.
0=Default. Writing `1' to the SLP_EN bit causes the
system to sequence into the sleeping state
associated with the SLP_TYPx fields.
1=Writing `1' to the SLP_EN bit does not cause the
system to sequence into the sleeping state
associated with the SLP_TYPx fields; instead an
SMI is generated.
Note: the SLP_EN_SMI bit in the SMI Status Register
2 is set whenever `1' is written to the SLP_EN bit;
it is enabled to generate an SMI through bit[0] of
this register.
Bit[1] WAK_CTRL. WAK_STS Bit Function
0=Default. The WAK_STS bit is set on the high-to-
low transition of nPowerOn.
1=The WAK_STS bit is set upon any enabled
wakeup event and the high-to-low transition of
nPowerOn.
Bits[2:7] Reserved
C
204
OPERATIONAL DESCRIPTION
MAXIMUM GUARANTEED RATINGS*
Operating Temperature Range......................................................................................... 0
o
C to +70
o
C
Storage Temperature Range..........................................................................................-55
o
to +150
o
C
Lead Temperature Range (soldering, 10 seconds) .................................................................... +325
o
C
Positive Voltage on any pin, with respect to Ground ................................................................V
cc
+0.3V
Negative Voltage on any pin, with respect to Ground.................................................................... -0.3V
Maximum V
cc
................................................................................................................................. +7V
*Stresses above those listed above could cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress
rating only and functional operation of the device at any other condition above those indicated in the
operation sections of this specification is not implied.
Note: When powering this device from laboratory or system power supplies, it is important that the
Absolute Maximum Ratings not be exceeded or device failure can result. Some power supplies exhibit
voltage spikes on their outputs when the AC power is switched on or off. In addition, voltage
transients on the AC power line may appear on the DC output. If this possibility exists, it is suggested
that a clamp circuit be used.
DC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
(T
A
= 0
°
C - 70
°
C, V
cc
= +5 V ± 10%)
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
I Type Input Buffer
Low Input Level
High Input Level
V
ILI
V
IHI
2.0
0.8
V
V
TTL Levels
IS Type Input Buffer
Low Input Level
High Input Level
Schmitt Trigger Hysteresis
V
ILIS
V
IHIS
V
HYS
2.2
250
0.8
V
V
mV
Schmitt Trigger
Schmitt Trigger
ICLK Input Buffer
Low Input Level
High Input Level
V
ILCK
V
IHCK
2.2
0.4
V
V
Input Leakage
(All I and IS buffers)
Low Input Leakage
High Input Leakage
I
IL
I
IH
-10
-10
+10
+10
µ
A
µ
A
V
IN
= 0
V
IN
= V
CC
205
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
OCLK2 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
3.5
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 2 mA
I
OH
= -2 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
IO4 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 4 mA
I
OH
= -2 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
IOP4 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
Backdrive Protected
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
I
IL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
± 10
V
V
µ
A
µ
A
I
OL
= 4 mA
I
OH
= -2 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
O4 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 4 mA
I
OH
= -2 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
O8 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 8 mA
I
OH
= -4 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
206
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
IO12 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 12 mA
I
OH
= -6 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
O12 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 12 mA
I
OH
= -6 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
OD12 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
I
OL
-10
0.4
+10
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 12 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
OP12 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
Backdrive Protected
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
I
IL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
± 10
V
V
µ
A
µ
A
I
OL
= 12 mA
I
OH
= -6 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
IOP14 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
Backdrive Protected
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
I
IL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
± 10
V
V
µ
A
µ
A
I
OL
= 14 mA
I
OH
= -14 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
207
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
OD14 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
I
OL
-10
0.4
+10
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 14 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
OP14 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
Backdrive Protected
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
I
IL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
± 10
V
V
µ
A
µ
A
I
OL
= 14 mA
I
OH
= -14 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
IOD16 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
I
OL
-10
0.4
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 16 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
O24 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 24 mA
I
OH
= -12 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
O24PD Type Buffer
Low Output Level
High Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
V
OH
I
OL
2.4
-10
0.4
+10
V
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 24 mA
I
OH
= -12 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
OD24 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
Output Leakage
V
OL
I
OL
0.4
+10
V
µ
A
I
OL
= 24 mA
V
IN
= 0 to V
CC
(Note 1)
208
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
ChiProtect
(SLCT, PE, BUSY, nACK,
nERROR, GP10-GP17,
GP50-GP54, GP60-GP67,)
I
IL
± 10
µ
A
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
Backdrive
(nSTROBE, nAUTOFD, nINIT,
nSLCTIN, PD0-PD7, GP10-
GP17, GP50-GP54, GP60-
GP67, nSMI, IRQ8)
I
IL
± 10
µ
A
V
CC
=0V; V
CC
=V
TR
=0V
V
IN
= 6V Max
V
CC
Supply Current Active
I
CCI
4.5
30
40
mA
All outputs open.
Trickle Supply Voltage
(Note 4)
V
TR
V
CC
min
-.5V
V
CC
max
V
V
CC
must not be
greater than .5V
above V
TR
V
TR
Supply Current Active
3
I
VRI
25
mA
All outputs open.
Battery Supply Voltage
3
V
BAT
2.4
3.0
4.0
V
V
BAT
Supply Current
3
Standby
Input Leakage
2.0
2.0
3.0
100
µ
A
nA
V
CC
=V
TR
=V
SS
=0V
V
CC
=5V, V
BAT
=3V
Note 1: Output leakage is are measured with the current pins in high impedance.
Note 2: Output leakage is measured with the low driving output off, either for a high level output or a
high impedance state.
Note 3: Please contact SMSC for the latest values.
Note 4: The minimum values given for V
TR
is for V
CC
active. When V
CC
=0, the minimum value given
for V
TR
is 0V.
CAPACITANCE T
A
= 25
°
°
C; fc = 1MHz; V
CC
= 5V
LIMITS
PARAMETER
SYMBOL
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNIT
TEST CONDITION
Clock Input Capacitance
C
IN
20
pF
Input Capacitance
C
IN
10
pF
Output Capacitance
C
OUT
20
pF
All pins except pin
under test tied to AC
ground
209
AC TIMING
CAPACITIVE LOADING
For the Timing Diagrams shown, the following capacitive loads (TABLE 76) are used.
TABLE 76 - CAPACITIVE LOADING
NAME
CAPACITANCE
TOTAL (pF)
SD[0:7]
120
IOCHRDY
120
IRQ[3:7,10:12]
60
DRQ[1:3]
60
nWGATE
240
nWDATA
240
nHDSEL
240
nDIR
240
nSTEP
240
nDS[1:0]
240
nMTR[1:0]
240
DRVDEN[1:0]
240
TXD1
100
nRTS1
100
nDTR1
100
TXD2
100
nRTS2
100
nDTR2
100
PD[0:7]
240
nSLCTIN
240
nINIT
240
nALF
240
nSTB
240
KDAT
240
KCLK
240
MDAT
240
MCLK
240
210
IOW Timing Port 92
FIGURE 9 - IOW TIMING FOR PORT 92
TABLE 77 - IOW TIMING FOR PORT 92
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
SAx Valid to nIOW Asserted
40
ns
t2
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
0
ns
t3
nIOW Asserted to SAx Invalid
10
ns
t4
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
0
ns
t5
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
100
ns
t2
t1
t4
t5
SAx
SD<7:0>
nIOW
t3
211
POWER-UP TIMING
FIGURE 10 - POWER-UP TIMING
TABLE 78 - POWER-UP TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
Vcc Slew from 4.5V to 0V
300
µ
s
t2
Vcc Slew from 0V to 4.5V
100
µ
s
t3
All Host Accesses After Powerup (Note 1)
125
500
µ
s
Note 1: Internal write-protection period after Vcc passes 4.5 volts on power-up
t3
Vcc
All Host
Accesses
t2
t1
212
Button Timing
FIGURE 11 - BUTTON INPUT TIMING
TABLE 79 - BUTTON INPUT TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t
R
, t
F
Button_In Rise/Fall Time
0.5
µ
s
FIGURE 12 - BUTTON OVERRIDE TIMING
TABLE 80 - BUTTON OVERRIDE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
Button_In Hold Time For Override Event
4
µ
s
t2
Button _In Low To nPowerOn Tristate and Vcc Low and
Start of Blanking Period
4
µ
s
t3
Blanking Period After Release of Button_In
4
µ
s
B u t t o n _ I n
t
F
t
R
V c c
n P o w e r O n
B u t t o n _ I n
t 2
t 1
t 3
B l a n k i n g P e r i o d
R e l e a s e
213
ROM INTERFACE
FIGURE 13 - ROM INTERFACE TIMING
Note 1: RD[x] driven by FDC37B72x, SD[x] driven by system
Note 2: RD[x] driven by ROM, SD[x] driven by FDC37B72x
TABLE 81 - ROM INTERFACE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
SD[x] Valid to RD[x] Valid
25
ns
t2
nROMCS Active to RD[X] Driven
25
ns
t3
nROMCS Inactive to RD[X] Float
25
ns
t4
RD[x] Valid to SD[x] Valid
25
ns
t5
nROMCS Active to SD[X] Driven
25
ns
t6
nROMCS Inactive to SD[X] Float
25
ns
t7
nROMOE Active to RD[x] Float
25
ns
t8
nROMOE Inactive to RD[x] Driven
25
ns
Note 1: Outputs have a 50 pf load.
t2
t1
t3
t2
t7
t8
t3
t5
t4
t6
N o t e 1
N o t e 2
n R O M C S
n R O M O E
R D [x]
SD[x]
214
ISA WRITE
FIGURE 14 - ISA WRITE TIMING
TABLE 82 - ISA WRITE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
SA[x], nCS and AEN valid to nIOW asserted
10
ns
t2
nIOW asserted to nIOW deasserted
80
ns
t3
nIOW asserted to SA[x], nCS invalid
10
ns
t4
SD[x] Valid to nIOW deasserted
45
ns
t5
SD[x] Hold from nIOW deasserted
0
ns
t6
nIOW deasserted to nIOW asserted
25
ns
t7
nIOW deasserted to FINTR deasserted (Note 1)
55
ns
t8
nIOW deasserted to PINTER deasserted (Note 2)
260
ns
t9
IBF (internal signal) asserted from nIOW deasserted
40
ns
t10
nIOW deasserted to AEN invalid
10
ns
Note 1: FINTR refers to the IRQ used by the floppy disk
Note 2: PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port
t10
t3
t1
t2
t4
t6
t5
t8
t9
DATA
AEN
SA[x],
nIOW
SD[x]
FINTR
PINTR
IBF
t7
215
ISA READ
FIGURE 15
- ISA READ TIMING
See timing parameters on next page (TABLE 83).
t13
t3
t1
t7
t2
t6
t4
t5
t10
t9
t11
t12
t8
DATA VALID
AEN
SA[x], nCS
nIOR
SD[x]
PD[x], nERROR,
PE, SLCT, ACK, BUSY
FINTER
PINTER
PCOBF
AUXOBF1
nIOR/nIOW
216
TABLE 83 - ISA READ TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
SA[x], nCS and AEN valid to nIOR asserted
10
ns
t2
nIOR asserted to nIOR deasserted
50
ns
t3
nIOR asserted to SA[x], nCS invalid
10
ns
t4
nIOR asserted to Data Valid
50
ns
t5
Data Hold/float from nIOR deasserted
10
25
ns
t6
nIOR deasserted
25
ns
t8
nIOR asserted after nIOW deasserted
80
ns
t8
nIOR/nIOR, nIOW/nIOW transfers from/to ECP FIFO
150
ns
t7
Parallel Port setup to nIOR asserted
20
ns
t9
nIOR asserted to PINTER deasserted
55
ns
t10
nIOR deasserted to FINTER deasserted
260
ns
t11
nIOR deasserted to PCOBF deasserted (Notes 3,5)
80
ns
t12
nIOR deasserted to AUXOBF1 deasserted (Notes 4,5)
80
ns
t13
nIOW deasserted to AEN invalid
10
ns
Note 1: FINTR refers to the IRQ used by the floppy disk.
Note 2: PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port.
Note 3: PCOBF is used for the Keyboard IRQ.
Note 4: AUXOBF1 is used for the Mouse IRQ.
Note 5: Applies only if deassertion is performed in hardware.
217
8042 CPU
FIGURE 16 - INTERNAL 8042 CPU TIMING
TABLE 84 - INTERNAL 8042 CPU TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nWRT deasserted to AUXOBF1 asserted (Notes 1,2)
40
ns
t2
nWRT deasserted to PCOBF asserted (Notes 1,3)
40
ns
t3
nRD deasserted to IBF deasserted (Note 1)
40
ns
Note 1: IBF, nWRT and nRD are internal signals.
Note 2: PCOBF is used for the Keyboard IRQ.
Note 3: AUXOBF1 is used for the Mouse IRQ.
t2
t1
t3
PCOBF
AUXOBF1
nWRT
IBF
nRD
218
CLOCK TIMING
FIGURE 17 - INPUT CLOCK TIMING
TABLE 85 - INPUT CLOCK TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
Clock Cycle Time for 14.318MHZ
70
ns
t2
Clock High Time/Low Time for 14.318MHz
35
ns
t1
Clock Cycle Time for 32KHZ
31.25
µ
s
t2
Clock High Time/Low Time for 32kHz
16.53
µ
s
Clock Rise Time/Fall Time (not shown)
5
ns
FIGURE 18 - RESET TIMING
TABLE 86 - RESET TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t4
RESET width (Note 1)
1.5
s
Note 1: The RESET width is dependent upon the processor clock. The RESET must be active while
the clock is running and stable.
t1
t2
t2
CLOCKI
t4
RESET_DRV
219
Single Transfer DMA
FIGURE 19 - SINGLE TRANSFER DMA TIMING
See timing parameters on next page (
TABLE 87
).
t15
t2
t3
t12
t16
t1
t4
t5
t6
t11
t14
t8
t7
t9
t10
t13
AEN
FDRQ,
PDRQ
nDACK
nIOR
or
nIOW
DATA
(DO-D7)
TC
DATA VALID
220
TABLE 87 - SINGLE TRANSFER DMA TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nDACK Delay Time from FDRQ High
0
ns
t2
DRQ Reset Delay from nIOR or nIOW
100
ns
t3
FDRQ Reset Delay from nDACK Low
100
ns
t4
nDACK Width
150
ns
t5
nIOR Delay from FDRQ High
0
ns
t6
nIOW Delay from FDRQ High
0
ns
t7
Data Access Time from nIOR Low
100
ns
t8
Data Set Up Time to nIOW High
40
ns
t9
Data to Float Delay from nIOR High
10
60
ns
t10
Data Hold Time from nIOW High
10
ns
t11
nDACK Set Up to nIOW/nIOR Low
5
ns
t12
nDACK Hold after nIOW/nIOR High
10
ns
t13
TC Pulse Width
60
ns
t14
AEN Set Up to nIOR/nIOW
40
ns
t15
AEN Hold from nDACK
10
ns
t16
TC Active to PDRQ Inactive
100
ns
221
Burst Transfer DMA Timing
FIGURE 20 - BURST TRANSFER DMA TIMING
See timing parameters on next page (
TABLE 88
).
t15
t2
t3
t12
t16
t1
t4
t5
t6
t11
t14
t8
t7
t9
t10
t13
AEN
FDRQ,
PDRQ
nDACK
nIOR
or
nIOW
DATA
(DO-D7)
TC
DATA VALID
DATA VALID
222
TABLE 88 - BURST TRANSFER DMA TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nDACK Delay Time from FDRQ High
0
ns
t2
DRQ Reset Delay from nIOR or nIOW
100
ns
t3
FDRQ Reset Delay from nDACK Low
100
ns
t4
nDACK Width
150
ns
t5
nIOR Delay from FDRQ High
0
ns
t6
nIOW Delay from FDRQ High
0
ns
t7
Data Access Time from nIOR Low
100
ns
t8
Data Set Up Time to nIOW High
40
ns
t9
Data to Float Delay from nIOR High
10
60
ns
t10
Data Hold Time from nIOW High
10
ns
t11
nDACK Set Up to nIOW/nIOR Low
5
ns
t12
nDACK Hold after nIOW/nIOR High
10
ns
t13
TC Pulse Width
60
ns
t14
AEN Set Up to nIOR/nIOW
40
ns
t15
AEN Hold from nDACK
10
ns
t16
TC Active to PDRQ Inactive
100
ns
223
DISK DRIVE TIMING
FIGURE 21 - DISK DRIVE TIMING (AT MODE ONLY)
TABLE 89 - DISK DRIVE TIMING (AT MODE ONLY)
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nDIR Set Up to STEP Low
4
X*
t2
nSTEP Active Time Low
24
X*
t3
nDIR Hold Time after nSTEP
96
X*
t4
nSTEP Cycle Time
132
X*
t5
nDS0-1 Hold Time from nSTEP Low
20
X*
t6
nINDEX Pulse Width
2
X*
t7
nRDATA Active Time Low
40
ns
t8
nWDATA Write Data Width Low
.5
Y*
t9
nDS0-1, MTRO-1 from End of nIOW
25
ns
*X specifies one MCLK period and Y specifies one WCLK period.
MCLK = 16 x Data Rate (at 500 kb/s MCLK = 8 MHz)
WCLK = 2 x Data Rate (at 500 kb/s WCLK = 1 MHz)
t3
t1
t2
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
t9
t9
nDIR
nSTEP
nDS0-3
nINDEX
nRDATA
nWDATA
nIOW
nDS0-1,
MTR0-1
224
SERIAL PORT
FIGURE 22 - SERIAL PORT TIMING
TABLE 90 - SERIAL PORT TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nRTSx, nDTRx Delay from nIOW
200
ns
t2
IRQx Active Delay from nCTSx, nDSRx, nDCDx
100
ns
t3
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOR (Leading Edge)
120
ns
t4
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOW (Trailing Edge)
125
ns
t5
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOW
10
100
ns
t6
IRQx Active Delay from nRIx
100
ns
t1
t5
t2
t4
t6
t3
nIOW
nRTSx,
nDTRx
IRQx
nCTSx,
nDSRx,
nDCDx
IRQx
nIOW
IRQx
nIOR
nRIx
225
PARALLEL PORT
FIGURE 23 - PARALLEL PORT TIMING
TABLE 91 - PARALLEL PORT TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
PD0-7, nINIT, nSTROBE, nAUTOFD Delay from
nIOW
100
ns
t2
PINTR Delay from nACK, nFAULT
60
ns
t3
PINTR Active Low in ECP and EPP Modes
200
300
ns
t4
PINTR Delay from nACK
105
ns
t5
nERROR Active to PINTR Active
105
ns
t6
PD0 - PD7 Delay from IOW Active
100
ns
Note:
PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port.
t1
t4
t3
t2
t2
t5
t3
nIOW
nINIT, nSTROBE.
nAUTOFD, SLCTIN
nACK
PINTR
(ECP or EPP Enabled)
nFAULT (ECP)
nERROR
(ECP)
PINTR
PD0- PD7
t6
nPINTR
(SPP)
226
EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE
FIGURE 24 - EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE
See timing parameters on next page (TABLE 92).
t18
t9
t8
t17
t12
t19
t10
t11
t13
t20
t22
t2
t1
t5
t3
t14
t16
t4
t6
t15
t7
t21
A0-A10
SD<7:0>
nIOW
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
PD<7:0>
nDATAST
nADDRSTB
nWAIT
PDIR
227
TABLE 92 - EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nIOW Asserted to PDATA Valid
0
50
ns
t2
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Change (Note 1)
60
185
ns
t3
nWRITE to Command Asserted
5
35
ns
t4
nWAIT Deasserted to Command Deasserted
(Note 1)
60
190
ns
t5
nWAIT Asserted to PDATA Invalid (Note 1)
0
ns
t6
Time Out
10
12
µ
s
t7
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Asserted
0
ns
t8
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
10
ns
t9
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
0
ns
t10
nIOW Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
0
24
ns
t11
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
(Note 1)
60
160
ns
t12
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOW Deasserted
10
ns
t13
nIOW Asserted to nWRITE Asserted
0
70
ns
t14
nWAIT Asserted to Command Asserted (Note 1)
60
210
ns
t15
Command Asserted to nWAIT Deasserted
0
10
s
t16
PDATA Valid to Command Asserted
10
ns
t17
Ax Valid to nIOW Asserted
40
ns
t18
nIOW Asserted to Ax Invalid
10
ns
t19
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
40
ns
t20
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Asserted (Note 1)
60
185
ns
t21
nWAIT Asserted to PDIR Low
0
ns
t22
PDIR Low to nWRITE Asserted
0
ns
Note 1: nWAIT must be filtered to compensate for ringing on the parallel bus cable. WAIT is
considered to have settled after it does not transition for a minimum of 50 nsec.
228
EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE
FIGURE 25 - EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE
See timing parameters on next page (TABLE 93)
t20
t19
t11
t22
t13
t12
t8
t10
t18
t23
t24
t27
t9
t21
t17
t2
t25
t5
t4
t16
t1
t14
t26
t28
t3
t7
t15
t6
PData bus driven
by peripheral
A0-A10
IOR
SD<7:0>
IOCHRDY
PDIR
nWRITE
PD<7:0>
DATASTB
ADDRSTB
nWAIT
229
TABLE 93 - EPP 1.9 DATA OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
PDATA Hi-Z to Command Asserted
0
30
ns
t2
nIOR Asserted to PDATA Hi-Z
0
50
ns
t3
nWAIT Deasserted to Command Deasserted
(Note 1)
60
180
ns
t4
Command Deasserted to PDATA Hi-Z
0
ns
t5
Command Asserted to PDATA Valid
0
ns
t6
PDATA Hi-Z to nWAIT Deasserted
0
µ
s
t7
PDATA Valid to nWAIT Deasserted
0
ns
t8
nIOR Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
0
24
ns
t9
nWRITE Deasserted to nIOR Asserted (Note 2)
0
ns
t10
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
(Note 1)
60
160
ns
t11
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOR Deasserted
0
ns
t12
nIOR Deasserted to SDATA Hi-Z (Hold Time)
0
40
ns
t13
PDATA Valid to SDATA Valid
0
75
ns
t14
nWAIT Asserted to Command Asserted
0
195
ns
t15
Time Out
10
12
µ
s
t16
nWAIT Deasserted to PDATA Driven (Note 1)
60
190
ns
t17
nWAIT Deasserted to nWRITE Modified (Notes 1,2)
60
190
ns
t18
SDATA Valid to IOCHRDY Deasserted (Note 3)
0
85
ns
t19
Ax Valid to nIOR Asserted
40
ns
t20
nIOR Deasserted to Ax Invalid
10
10
ns
t21
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Deasserted
0
185
ns
t22
nIOR Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
40
ns
t23
nWAIT Asserted to PDIR Set (Note 1)
60
185
ns
t24
PDATA Hi-Z to PDIR Set
0
ns
t25
nWAIT Asserted to PDATA Hi-Z (Note 1)
60
180
ns
t26
PDIR Set to Command
0
20
ns
t27
nWAIT Deasserted to PDIR Low (Note 1)
60
180
ns
t28
nWRITE Deasserted to Command
1
ns
Note 1: nWAIT is considered to have settled after it does not transition for a minimum of 50 ns.
Note 2: When not executing a write cycle, EPP nWRITE is inactive high.
Note 3: 85 is true only if t7 = 0.
230
EPP 1.7 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE
FIGURE 26 - EPP 1.7 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE
See timing parameters on next page (TABLE 94).
t18
t9
t8
t17
t6
t12
t19
t10
t20
t11
t13
t2
t1
t5
t3
t16
t4
t21
A0-A10
SD<7:0>
nIOW
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
PD<7:0>
nDATAST
nADDRSTB
nWAIT
PDIR
231
TABLE 94 - EPP 1.7 DATA OR ADDRESS WRITE CYCLE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nIOW Asserted to PDATA Valid
0
50
ns
t2
Command Deasserted to nWRITE Change
0
40
ns
t3
nWRITE to Command
5
35
ns
t4
nIOW Deasserted to Command Deasserted (Note 2)
50
ns
t5
Command Deasserted to PDATA Invalid
50
ns
t6
Time Out
10
12
µ
s
t8
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
10
ns
t9
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
0
ns
t10
nIOW Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
0
24
ns
t11
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
40
ns
t12
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOW Deasserted
10
ns
t13
nIOW Asserted to nWRITE Asserted
0
50
ns
t16
PDATA Valid to Command Asserted
10
35
ns
t17
Ax Valid to nIOW Asserted
40
ns
t18
nIOW Deasserted to Ax Invalid
10
µ
s
t19
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
100
ns
t20
nWAIT Asserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
45
ns
t21
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Deasserted
0
ns
Note 1: nWRITE is controlled by clearing the PDIR bit to "0" in the control register before performing
an EPP Write.
Note 2: The number is only valid if nWAIT is active when IOW goes active.
232
EPP 1.7 DATA OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE
FIGURE 27 - EPP 1.7 DATA OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE
See timing parameters on next page (TABLE 95).
t20
t19
t11
t15
t22
t13
t12
t3
t8
t10
t5
t4
t23
t2
t21
A0-A10
nIOR
SD<7:0>
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
PD<7:0>
nDATASTB
nADDRSTB
nWAIT
PDIR
233
TABLE 95 - EPP 1.7 DAT OR ADDRESS READ CYCLE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t2
nIOR Deasserted to Command Deasserted
50
ns
t3
nWAIT Asserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
0
40
ns
t4
Command Deasserted to PDATA Hi-Z
0
ns
t5
Command Asserted to PDATA Valid
0
ns
t8
nIOR Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
24
ns
t10
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
50
ns
t11
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOR Deasserted
0
ns
t12
nIOR Deasserted to SDATA High-Z (Hold Time)
0
40
ns
t13
PDATA Valid to SDATA Valid
40
ns
t15
Time Out
10
12
µ
s
t19
Ax Valid to nIOR Asserted
40
ns
t20
nIOR Deasserted to Ax Invalid
10
ns
t21
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Deasserted
0
ns
t22
nIOR Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
40
ns
t23
nIOR Asserted to Command Asserted
55
ns
Note:
WRITE is controlled by setting the PDIR bit to "1" in the control register before performing an
EPP Read.
234
ECP PARALLEL PORT TIMING
Parallel Port FIFO (Mode 101)
The standard parallel port is run at or near the
peak 500KBytes/sec allowed in the forward
direction using DMA. The state machine does
not examine nACK and begins the next transfer
based on Busy. Refer to FIGURE 29.
ECP Parallel Port Timing
The timing is designed to allow operation at
approximately 2.0 Mbytes/sec over a 15ft cable.
If a shorter cable is used then the bandwidth will
increase.
Forward-Idle
When the host has no data to send it keeps
HostClk (nStrobe) high and the peripheral will
leave PeriphClk (Busy) low.
Forward Data Transfer Phase
The interface transfers data and commands
from the host to the peripheral using an inter-
locked PeriphAck and HostClk. The peripheral
may indicate its desire to send data to the host
by asserting nPeriphRequest.
The Forward Data Transfer Phase may be
entered from the Forward-Idle Phase. While in
the Forward Phase the peripheral may
asynchronously assert the nPeriphRequest
(nFault) to request that the channel be reversed.
When the peripheral is not busy it sets
PeriphAck (Busy) low. The host then sets
HostClk (nStrobe) low when it is prepared to
send data. The data must be stable for the
specified setup time prior to the falling edge of
HostClk. The peripheral then sets PeriphAck
(Busy) high to acknowledge the handshake. The
host then sets HostClk (nStrobe) high. The
peripheral then accepts the data and sets
PeriphAck (Busy) low, completing the transfer.
This sequence is shown in FIGURE 29.
The timing is designed to provide 3 cable
round-trip times for data setup if Data is driven
simultaneously with HostClk (nStrobe).
Reverse-Idle Phase
The peripheral has no data to send and keeps
PeriphClk high. The host is idle and keeps
HostAck low.
Reverse Data Transfer Phase
The interface transfers data and commands
from the peripheral to the host using an inter-
locked HostAck and PeriphClk. The Reverse
Data Transfer Phase may be entered from the
Reverse-Idle Phase. After the previous byte has
beed accepted the host sets HostAck (nALF)
low. The peripheral then sets PeriphClk (nACK)
low when it has data to send. The data must be
stable for the specified setup time prior to the
falling edge of PeriphClk. When the host is
ready to accept a byte it sets HostAck (nALF)
high to acknowledge the handshake. The
peripheral then sets PeriphClk (nACK) high.
After the host has accepted the data it sets
HostAck (nALF) low, completing the transfer.
This sequence is shown in FIGURE 30.
Output Drivers
To facilitate higher performance data transfer,
the use of balanced CMOS active drivers for
critical signals (Data, HostAck, HostClk,
PeriphAck, PeriphClk) are used ECP Mode.
Because the use of active drivers can present
compatibility problems in Compatible Mode (the
control signals, by tradition, are specified as
open-collector), the drivers are dynamically
changed from open-collector to totem-pole. The
timing for the dynamic driver change is specified
in the IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port
Protocol and ISA Interface Standard, Rev. 1.14,
July 14, 1993, available from Microsoft. The
dynamic driver change must be implemented
properly to prevent glitching the outputs.
235
TABLE 96 - PARALLEL PORT FIFO TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
DATA Valid to nSTROBE Active
600
ns
t2
nSTROBE Active Pulse Width
600
ns
t3
DATA Hold from nSTROBE Inactive (Note 1)
450
ns
t4
nSTROBE Active to BUSY Active
500
ns
t5
BUSY Inactive to nSTROBE Active
680
ns
t6
BUSY Inactive to PDATA Invalid (Note 1)
80
ns
Note 1: The data is held until BUSY goes inactive or for time t3, whichever is longer. This only
applies if another data transfer is pending. If no other data transfer is pending, the data is
held indefinitely.
t3
t6
t1
t2
t5
t4
PDATA
nSTROBE
BUSY
FIGURE 28 - PARALLEL PORT FIFO TIMING
236
FIGURE 29 - ECP PARALLEL PORT FORWARD TIMING
TABLE 97 - ECP PARALLEL PORT FORWARD TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
nAUTOFD Valid to nSTROBE Asserted
0
60
ns
t2
PDATA Valid to nSTROBE Asserted
0
60
ns
t3
BUSY Deasserted to nAUTOFD Changed
(Notes 1,2)
80
180
ns
t4
BUSY Deasserted to PDATA Changed (Notes 1,2)
80
180
ns
t5
nSTROBE Deasserted to Busy Asserted
0
ns
t6
nSTROBE Deasserted to Busy Deasserted
0
ns
t7
BUSY Deasserted to nSTROBE Asserted (Notes 1,2)
80
200
ns
t8
BUSY Asserted to nSTROBE Deasserted (Note 2)
80
180
ns
Note 1: Maximum value only applies if there is data in the FIFO waiting to be written out.
Note 2: BUSY is not considered asserted or deasserted until it is stable for a minimum of 75 to 130
ns.
t3
t4
t1
t2
t7
t8
t6
t5
t6
nAUTOFD
PDATA<7:0>
BUSY
nSTROBE
237
FIGURE 30 - ECP PARALLEL PORT REVERSE TIMING
TABLE 98 - ECP PARALLEL PORT REVERSE TIMING
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
PDATA Valid to nACK Asserted
0
ns
t2
nAUTOFD Deasserted to PDATA Changed
0
ns
t3
nACK Asserted to nAUTOFD Deasserted
(Notes 1,2)
80
200
ns
t4
nACK Deasserted to nAUTOFD Asserted (Note 2)
80
200
ns
t5
nAUTOFD Asserted to nACK Asserted
0
ns
t6
nAUTOFD Deasserted to nACK Deasserted
0
ns
Note 1: Maximum value only applies if there is room in the FIFO and terminal count has not been
received. ECP can stall by keeping nAUTOFD low.
Note 2: nACK is not considered asserted or deasserted until it is stable for a minimum of 75 to 130
ns.
t2
t1
t5
t6
t4
t3
t4
PDATA<7:0>
nACK
nAUTOFD
238
SERIAL PORT INFRARED TIMING
IRDA SIR RECEIVE
FIGURE 31 - IRDA SIR RECEIVE TIMING
t1
t2
t2
t1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
DATA
IRRX
n IRRX
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
Parameter
min
typ
max
units
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
2.71
3.69
5.53
11.07
22.13
44.27
88.55
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Pulse Width at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
Bit Time at
1.6
3.22
4.8
9.7
19.5
39
78
8.68
17.4
26
52
104
208
416
1. Receive Pulse Detection Criteria: A received pulse is considered
received pulse is a minimum of 1.41µs.
2. IRRX: L5, CRF1 Bit 0
nIRRX: L5, CRF1 Bit 0 = 0
239
IRDA SIR TRANSMIT
FIGURE 32 - IRDA SIR TRANSMIT TIMING
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
Parameter
mi n
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
max
2.71
3.69
5.53
11.07
22.13
44.27
88.55
u nits
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
Pulse Width at 115kbaud
Pulse Width at 57.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 38.4kbaud
Pulse Width at 19.2kbaud
Pulse Width at 9.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 4.8kbaud
Pulse Width at 2.4kbaud
Bit Time at 115kbaud
Bit Time at 57.6kbaud
Bit Time at 38.4kbaud
Bit Time at 19.2kbaud
Bit Time at 9.6kbaud
Bit Time at 4.8kbaud
Bit Time at 2.4kbaud
typ
1.6
3.22
4.8
9.7
19.5
39
78
8.68
17.4
26
52
104
208
416
t1
t2
t2
t1
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
DAT A
IRT X
n IRT X
Notes:
1. I rDA @ 115k is HPSIR compatible. IrDA @ 2400 will allow compatibility with HP95LX
and 48SX.
2. IRT X: L5, CRF 1 Bit 1 = 1 (default)
nIRT X: L5, CRF1 Bit 1 = 0
240
ASK IR RECEIVE
FIGURE 33 - AMPLITUDE SHIFT KEYED IR RECEIVE TIMING
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
P a ramet er
min
typ
max
un its
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
Modulated Out put Bit Time
Off Bit Time
Modu lated Outp ut " On"
Modu lated Out put " Off"
Modu lated Outp ut " On"
Modu lated Out put " Off"
1
1
1
1
Note s:
1 . IRRX: L 5, CRF 1 Bit 0 = 1
n IRRX: L5 , CRF1 Bit 0 = 0 (de fault)
MIRRX, nMI RRX are the mod ulate d ou tpu ts
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
DATA
IRRX
n IRRX
M IRRX
nM IRRX
241
ASK IR TRANSMIT
FIGURE 34 - ASK IR TRANSMIT TIMING
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
Parameter
min
typ
max
units
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.8
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
µ s
Modulated Output Bit Time
Off Bit Time
Modulated Output "On"
Modulated Output "Off"
Modulated Output "On"
Modulated Output "Off"
1
1
1
1
Notes:
1. IRTX: L5, CRF1 Bit 1 = 1 (default)
nIRTX: L5, CRF1 Bit 1 = 0
MIRTX, nMIRTX are the modulated outputs
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
DATA
IRTX
n IRTX
MIRTX
nMIRTX
242
FIGURE 35 ­ 128 PIN QFP PACKAGE OUTLINE
3) Package body dimensions D1 and E1 do not include the mold protrusion. Maximum
mold protrusion is 0.25 mm.
Notes:
1) Coplanarity is 0.08 mm or 3.2 mils maximum.
2) Tolerance on the position of the leads is 0.080 mm maximum.
4) Dimensions for foot length L measured at the gauge plane 0.25 mm above the seating plane.
5) Details of pin 1 identifier are optional but must be located within the zone indicated.
6) Controlling dimension: millimeter
L1
L
DETAIL "A"
R1
R2
4
0
0.10
-C-
H
A
A1
A2
1
SEE DETAIL "A"
0
A
A1
A2
D
D1
E
E1
H
MIN
0.05
2.55
23.65
19.9
17.65
13.9
NOM
23.9
20
17.9
14
MAX
3.4
0.5
3.05
24.15
20.1
18.15
14.1
NOM
0.8
1.95
L
L1
e
0
W
R1
R2
MIN
0.65
0
0.1
0.13
0.13
MAX
0.95
7
0.3
0.3
0.5BSC
E1
E
D1
D
W
3
3
e
2
D1/4
E1/4
5
39
38
64
65
102
103
128
1
243
FDC37B72x ERRATTA SHEET
PAGE
SECTION/FIGURE/ENTRY
CORRECTION
DATE
REVISED
85
Figure 3/Heading
See Italicized Text
1/8/99
142
Table
See Italicized Text
1/8/99
© 1999 STANDARD MICROSYSTEMS CORPORATION (SMSC)
Circuit diagrams utilizing SMSC products are included as a means of illustrating typical applications; consequently complete
information sufficient for construction purposes is not necessarily given. The information has been carefully checked and is believed
to be entirely reliable. However, no responsibility is assumed for inaccuracies. Furthermore, such information does not convey to the
purchaser of the semiconductor devices described any licenses under the patent rights of SMSC or others. SMSC reserves the right
to make changes at any time in order to improve design and supply the best product possible. SMSC products are not designed,
intended, authorized or warranted for use in any life support or other application where product failure could cause or contribute to
personal injury or severe property damage. Any and all such uses without prior written approval of an Officer of SMSC and further
testing and/or modification will be fully at the risk of the customer.
FDC37B72x Rev. 1/8/99